blob: 85f228a262d4cfd6092c0da3d575c364d9420e4a [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau62f11a52020-07-04 07:10:24 +02007 2020/07/04
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100599 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200600 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100603 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100605 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200606 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200608 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200611 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - presetenv
613 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - uid
615 - ulimit-n
616 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200617 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200629 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200672 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200673 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200674 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200675 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100676 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200677 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200678 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200679 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100680 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100682 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.session-timeout
684 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200685 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100686 - tune.maxaccept
687 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200688 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200689 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200690 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200691 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
692 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200697 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.sndbuf.client
699 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100700 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200701 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200703 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100704 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200705 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200706 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100707 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100709 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200710 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
711 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
712 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100713 - tune.zlib.memlevel
714 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716 * Debugging
717 - debug
718 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200719 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007223.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723------------------------------------
724
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200725ca-base <dir>
726 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100727 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
728 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
729 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731chroot <jail dir>
732 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
733 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
734 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
735 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
736 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100737 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100738
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
740 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
741 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
742 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
743 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
744 set. These sets have the format
745
746 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
747
748 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
751 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
753 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
759 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
760 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
761 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100762
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100763 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
764 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
765 on the machine's word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
769 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
770 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
771 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
772 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
773 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100774
775 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
779 # first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
782 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
783 # word size.
784
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100786 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
790
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100791 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
792 # and so on.
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100798 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
799 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
800 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
801
802 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
803 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
804 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
805
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100806 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
807 # and a thread range.
808 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
810 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
811
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200812crt-base <dir>
813 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100814 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
815 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817daemon
818 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
819 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100820 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
821 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823deviceatlas-json-file <path>
824 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826
827deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
830
831deviceatlas-separator <char>
832 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
833 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
834
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100835deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200836 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
837 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
838 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100839
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100841 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
842 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100843 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
844 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
845 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
846 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
847 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900848
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849gid <number>
850 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
851 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
852 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100853 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
854 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200855 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100856
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100857group <group name>
858 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
859 See also "gid" and "user".
860
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100861hard-stop-after <time>
862 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
863
864 Arguments :
865 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
866 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
867 SIGUSR1 signal.
868
869 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
870 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
871 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
872
873 Example:
874 global
875 hard-stop-after 30s
876
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200877h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
878 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
879 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
880 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
881 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500882 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200883 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
884 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
885 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
886 specified in a proxy.
887
888 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
889 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
890 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
891 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
892 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
893 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
894 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
895
896 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
897 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
898 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
899 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
900 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
901
902 Example:
903 global
904 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
905
906 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
907 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
908
909h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
910 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
911 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
912 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
913 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
914 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
915 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
916 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
917 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
918
919 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
920 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
921 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
922
923 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
924 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
925
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100926insecure-fork-wanted
927 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
928 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
929 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
930 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
931 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
932 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
933 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
934 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
935 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
936 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
937 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
938 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
939 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
940 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
941 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
942 disable it.
943
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100944insecure-setuid-wanted
945 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
946 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
947 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
948 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
949 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
950 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
951 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
952 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
953 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
954 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
955 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
956 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
957 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
958 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
959
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100960issuers-chain-path <dir>
961 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
962 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
963 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
964 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
965 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
966 "issuers-chain-path".
967 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
968 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
969 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
970 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
971 will share the chain in memory.
972
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200973localpeer <name>
974 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
975 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
976 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
977 the configuration parsing.
978
979 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
980 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
981
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200982log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
983 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100984 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100985 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 configured with "log global".
987
988 <address> can be one of:
989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100990 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
992 port).
993
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100994 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
995 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
996 port).
997
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100998 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100999 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1000 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001001 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001003 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1004 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1005 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1006 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1007 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1008 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1009 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1010 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1011 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1012 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1013 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1014 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1015 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1016 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001017 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1018 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001019
1020 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1021 "fd@2", see above.
1022
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001023 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1024 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1025 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1026 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1027 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1028
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001029 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1030 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001031
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1033 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1034 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1035 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1036 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1037 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1038 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1039 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1040 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1041 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1043 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001044
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001045 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1046 one of the following :
1047
1048 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1049 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1050
1051 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1053
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001054 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1055 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1056 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1057 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1058 logger consumes.
1059
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001060 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1061 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1062 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1063 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1064
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001065 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1066 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1067 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1068 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1069 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1070
1071 <sample_size>
1072 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1073 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1074 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1075 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1076 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1077
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001078 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001080 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1081 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1082 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1083
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001084 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1085 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1086 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1087 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
1089 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001090 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1091 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1092 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1093 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1094 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1095 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001097 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001098
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001099log-send-hostname [<string>]
1100 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1101 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1102 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1103 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1104 the logs.
1105
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001106log-tag <string>
1107 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1108 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1109 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001110 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001111
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001112lua-load <file>
1113 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1114 used multiple times.
1115
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001116lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1117 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1118 variable.
1119 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1120 to "path".
1121
1122 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1123 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1124 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1125 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1126 will be checked earlier.
1127
1128 As an example by specifying the following path:
1129
1130 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1131 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1132
1133 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1134 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1135 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1136 paths if that does not exist either.
1137
1138 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1139 documentation.
1140
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001141master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1143 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1144 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001145 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001146 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1147 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001148 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1149 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1150 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1151 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1152 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001153
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001154 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001155
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001156mworker-max-reloads <number>
1157 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001158 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001159 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1160 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1161 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1162
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001163nbproc <number>
1164 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1165 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1166 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001167 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1168 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001169 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1170 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001172nbthread <number>
1173 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001174 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1175 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1176 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1177 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1178 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001179 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1180 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1181 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1182 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1183 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1184 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1185 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001186
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001187pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001188 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001189 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1190 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1191
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001192pp2-never-send-local
1193 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1194 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1195 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1196 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1197 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1198 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1199 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1200 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1201 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1202 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1203 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1204
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001205presetenv <name> <value>
1206 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1207 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1208 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1209 and "unsetenv".
1210
1211resetenv [<name> ...]
1212 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1213 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1214 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1215 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1216 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1217 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1218 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1219 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1220
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001221stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001222 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1223 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1224 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1225 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1226 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1227 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001228 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001229 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1230 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1231 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1232 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001233
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001234server-state-base <directory>
1235 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001236 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1237 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001238
1239server-state-file <file>
1240 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1241 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1242 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1243 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1244 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1245 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1246 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1247 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001248 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1249 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001250
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001251setenv <name> <value>
1252 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1253 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1254 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1255 and "unsetenv".
1256
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001257set-dumpable
1258 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001259 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1260 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1261 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1262 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1263 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1264 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1265 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1266 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1267 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1268 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1269 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1270 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1271 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1272 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1273 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1274 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1275 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001276
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001277ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1279 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001280 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001281 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001282 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1283 information and recommendations see e.g.
1284 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1285 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1286 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1287 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001288
1289ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1291 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1292 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1293 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1294 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001295 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1296 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1297 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001298 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001299
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001300ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1302 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1303 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1304 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1305 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1306
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001307ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1309 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1310 keyword to see available options.
1311
1312 Example:
1313 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001314 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001315
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001316ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1318 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001319 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001320 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001321 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1322 information and recommendations see e.g.
1323 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1324 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1325 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1326 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1327 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001328
1329ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1331 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1332 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1333 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1334 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001335 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1336 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1337 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1338 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001339
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001340ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1342 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1343 keyword to see available options.
1344
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001345ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1347 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1348 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001349 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001350 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001351 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1352 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1353 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1354 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001355 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1356 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1357 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1358
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001359ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001360 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1361 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1362
1363 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1364 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1365 optimize the startup time.
1366
1367 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1368 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1369 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1370
1371 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001372 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001373
1374 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1375 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1376 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1377 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1378 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1379 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001380 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001381 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1382
1383 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1384
1385 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1386
1387 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1388 not provided in the PEM file.
1389
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001390 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1391 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1392
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001393 The default behavior is "all".
1394
1395 Example:
1396 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1397 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1398 ssl-load-extra-files none
1399
1400 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1401
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001402ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1403 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1404 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1405 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1406
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001407ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001408 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001409 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1410 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1411 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1412 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1413 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1414 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1415 bits does not need it.
1416
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001417stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1418 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1419 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1420 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001421 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001422 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001423
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001424 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1425 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1426 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001427
1428stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1429 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1430 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001431 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001432
1433stats maxconn <connections>
1434 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1435 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1436
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001437uid <number>
1438 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1439 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1440 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1441 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1442
1443ulimit-n <number>
1444 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1445 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1446 option.
1447
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001448unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1449 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1450
1451 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1452 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1453 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1454 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1455 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1456 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1457 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1458 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1459 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1460 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1461
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001462unsetenv [<name> ...]
1463 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1464 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1465 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1466 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1467 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1468 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1469 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001471user <user name>
1472 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1473 See also "uid" and "group".
1474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001475node <name>
1476 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1477
1478 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1479 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1480 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1481 traffic.
1482
1483description <text>
1484 Add a text that describes the instance.
1485
1486 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1487 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1488 "<" and ">" characters.
1489
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100149051degrees-data-file <file path>
1491 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001492 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001494 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001495 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1496
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000149751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001498 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1499 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1500 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1501
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001502 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001503 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1504
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200150551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001506 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1507 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1508
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001509 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1510 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1511
151251degrees-cache-size <number>
1513 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1514 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1515 By default, this cache is disabled.
1516
1517 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001518 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1519
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001520wurfl-data-file <file path>
1521 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1522 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1523
1524 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1525 with USE_WURFL=1.
1526
1527wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1528 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1529 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1530 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1531
1532 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1533
1534 Valid WURFL properties are:
1535 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1536
1537 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1538 device.
1539
1540 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1541 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1542
1543 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1544 particular web request.
1545
1546 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1547 used Libwurfl API version.
1548
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001549 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1550 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1551
1552 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1553 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1554
1555 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1556
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001557 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1558 with USE_WURFL=1.
1559
1560wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1561 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1562 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1563
1564 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1565 with USE_WURFL=1.
1566
1567wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1568 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1569 thus before the chroot.
1570
1571 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1572 with USE_WURFL=1.
1573
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001574wurfl-cache-size <size>
1575 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1576 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001577 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001578 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001579
1580 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1581 with USE_WURFL=1.
1582
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001583strict-limits
1584 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1585 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1586 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1587 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1588 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1589 keyword.
1590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015913.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001592-----------------------
1593
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001594busy-polling
1595 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1596 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1597 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1598 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1599 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1600 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1601 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1602 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1603 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1604 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1605 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1606 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1607 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1608 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1609 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1610 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1611 "poll" pollers.
1612
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001613 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1614 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1615 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1616
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001617max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1618 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1619 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1620 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1621 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1622 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1623 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1624 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1625 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001627maxconn <number>
1628 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1629 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1630 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001631 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1632 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1633 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1634 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001635 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1636 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1637 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1638 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1639 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1640 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001641
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001642maxconnrate <number>
1643 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1644 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1645 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1646 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1647 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1648 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1649 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1650 fairness.
1651
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001652maxcomprate <number>
1653 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001654 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001655 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1656 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1657 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001658 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001659 default value.
1660
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001661maxcompcpuusage <number>
1662 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1663 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1664 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1665 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1666 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1667 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1668 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1669 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1670
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001671maxpipes <number>
1672 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1673 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1674 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1675 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1676 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1677 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1678
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001679maxsessrate <number>
1680 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1681 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1682 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1683 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1684 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1685 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1686 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1687 fairness.
1688
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001689maxsslconn <number>
1690 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1691 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1692 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1693 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1694 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1695 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1696 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001697 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1698 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1699 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1700 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1701 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1702 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1703 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001704
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001705maxsslrate <number>
1706 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1707 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1708 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1709 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1710 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1711 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1712 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1713 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1714 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1715 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1716
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001717maxzlibmem <number>
1718 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1719 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1720 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001721 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1722 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1723 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1724
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001725noepoll
1726 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1727 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001728 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729
1730nokqueue
1731 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1732 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1733 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1734
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001735noevports
1736 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1737 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1738 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1739 also "nopoll".
1740
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001741nopoll
1742 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1743 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001745 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1746 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001747
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001748nosplice
1749 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001750 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001751 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001752 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001753 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1754 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1755 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1756 "option splice-response".
1757
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001758nogetaddrinfo
1759 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1760 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1761
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001762noreuseport
1763 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1764 command line argument "-dR".
1765
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001766profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1767 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1768 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1769 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1770 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001771 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001772 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1773 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1774 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1775 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1776
1777 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1778 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1779 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1780 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1781 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001782 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1783 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1784 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1785 CLI.
1786
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001787spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001788 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1789 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1790 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1791 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1792 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1793 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001795ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001796 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001797 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001798 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1799 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1800 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1801 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1802 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001803 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1804 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001805 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1806 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1807 openssl configuration file uses:
1808 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1809
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001810ssl-mode-async
1811 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001812 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001813 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1814 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1815 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001816 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001817 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001818
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001819tune.buffers.limit <number>
1820 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1821 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1822 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1823 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1824 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001825 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001826 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1827 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1828 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1829 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1830 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1831 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1832 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1833 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1834 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1835
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001836tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1837 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1838 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1839 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1840 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1841
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001842tune.bufsize <number>
1843 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1844 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1845 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1846 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1847 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1848 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1849 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001850 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1851 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1852 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001853 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001854 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1855 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1856 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001857
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001858tune.chksize <number>
1859 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1860 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1861 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1862 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1863 checks whenever possible.
1864
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001865tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1866 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1867 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1868 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1869 this value. The default value is 1.
1870
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001871tune.fail-alloc
1872 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1873 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1874 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1875 gracefully.
1876
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001877tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1878 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1879 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1880 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1881 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1882 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1883
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001884tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1885 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1886 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1887 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1888 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1889 change it.
1890
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001891tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1892 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001893 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1894 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001895 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1896 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1897 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1898 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1899 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1900
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001901tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1902 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1903 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1904 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1905 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1906 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1907 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1908 recommended not to change this value.
1909
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001910tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1911 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1912 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1913 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1914 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1915 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1916 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1917 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1918
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001919tune.http.cookielen <number>
1920 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1921 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1922 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1923 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1924 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1925 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1926 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1927 to change this value.
1928
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001929tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001930 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1931 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001932 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001933 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001934 configuration directives too.
1935 The default value is 1024.
1936
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001937tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1938 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1939 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1940 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1941 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1942 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1943 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001944 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1945 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1946 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001947
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001948tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1949 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1950 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1951 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1952 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1953 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1954 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1955 this option to "off". The default is on.
1956
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001957tune.idletimer <timeout>
1958 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1959 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1960 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1961 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1962 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1963 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001964 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001965 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001966 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1967
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001968tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1969 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1970 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1971 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1972 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1973 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1974 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1975 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1976 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1977 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1978
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001979tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1980 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001981 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001982 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1983 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001984 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001985 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1986 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1987
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001988tune.lua.maxmem
1989 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1990 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1991 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1992 memory.
1993
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001994tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1995 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001996 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1997 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001998 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001999
2000tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2001 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2002 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2003 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2004 check servers.
2005
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002006tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2007 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2008 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2009 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002010 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002011
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002012tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002013 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2014 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2015 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2016 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2017 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2018 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2019 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2020 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2021 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2022 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002023
2024tune.maxpollevents <number>
2025 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2026 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2027 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2028 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2029 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2030
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002031tune.maxrewrite <number>
2032 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2033 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2034 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2035 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2036 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2037 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2038 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2039 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2040 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2041 bufsize.
2042
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002043tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2044 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2045 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2046 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2047 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2048 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2049 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2050 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2051 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2052 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002053 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2054 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002055 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2056 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2057 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2058 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2059 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2060 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2061 setting this parameter to 0.
2062
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002063tune.pipesize <number>
2064 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2065 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2066 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2067 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2068 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2069 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2070
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002071tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2072 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2073 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2074 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2075 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2076 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2077 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002078 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002079
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002080tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2081 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2082 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2083 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2084 default is 20.
2085
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002086tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2087tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2088 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2089 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2090 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002091 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002092 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002093 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2094 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2095
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002096tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002097 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002098 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2099 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2100 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2101 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2102
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002103tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002104 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002105 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002106 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2107 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2108 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2109
2110tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2111 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2112 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2113 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2114 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2115 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2116 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2117 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2118 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2119 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002120
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002121tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2122tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2123 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2124 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2125 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002126 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002127 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002128 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2129 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2130 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2131 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2132 notifying haproxy again.
2133
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002134tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002135 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2136 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2137 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002138 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002139 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002140 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002141 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2142 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2143 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002144 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2145 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002146
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002147tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002148 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002149 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2150 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2151 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2152 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2153 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2154
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002155tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2156 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2157 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2158 performances. This is disabled by default.
2159
2160 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2161 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2162
2163 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2164
2165 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2166
2167 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2168
2169 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2170 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2171 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2172
2173 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2174 converted.
2175
2176 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2177 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2178 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2179 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2180 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2181 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2182 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002183 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2184 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002185
2186 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2187
2188 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2189 only need this line:
2190
2191 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2192
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002193tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2194 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002195 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002196 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2197 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2198 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2199 being used for too long.
2200
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002201tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2202 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2203 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2204 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2205 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2206 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2207 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2208 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2209 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2210 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2211 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002212 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002213 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002214
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002215tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2216 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2217 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2218 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2219 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002220 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002221 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2222 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002223 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2224 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002225
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002226tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2227 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2228 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2229 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2230 1000 entries.
2231
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002232tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2233 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2234 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2235 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2236
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002237tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002238tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002239tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2240tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2241tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002242 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2243 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2244 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2245 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2246 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2247 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2248 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2249 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002250
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002251 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2252 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2253 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2254 all available space is consumed.
2255 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2256 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2257 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002258
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002259tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2260 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002261 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002262 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002263 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002264 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2265
2266tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2267 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2268 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002269 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2270 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022723.3. Debugging
2273--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002274
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002275debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002276 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2277 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2278 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2279 system startup.
2280
2281quiet
2282 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2283 line argument "-q".
2284
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002285zero-warning
2286 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2287 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2288 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2289 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2290 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2291 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2292
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022943.4. Userlists
2295--------------
2296It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2297http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2298it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2299
2300userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002301 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002302 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2303
2304group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002305 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002306 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2307 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2308
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002309user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2310 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002311 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2312 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002313 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2314 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2315 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2316 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002317
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002318 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2319 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2320 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2321 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2322 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2323 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2324 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2325 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2326 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002327
2328 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002329 userlist L1
2330 group G1 users tiger,scott
2331 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002332
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002333 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2334 user scott insecure-password elgato
2335 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002336
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002337 userlist L2
2338 group G1
2339 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002340
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002341 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2342 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2343 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002344
2345 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002346
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002347
23483.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002349----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002350It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2351several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2352instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2353values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2354automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2355In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2356using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2357tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2358reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2359Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2360that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2361each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002362
2363peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002364 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002365 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2366
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002367bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2368 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2369 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2370
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002371disabled
2372 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2373 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2374 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2375
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002376default-bind [param*]
2377 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2378
2379default-server [param*]
2380 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2381
2382 Arguments:
2383 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2384 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2385 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2386 details.
2387
2388
2389 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2390
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002391enable
2392 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2393
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002394log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2395 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2396 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2397 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2398 more details.
2399
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002400peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002401 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2402 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002403 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2404 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2405 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2406 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2407 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002408
2409 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2410 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2411
2412 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002413 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2414 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2415 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002416
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002417 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2418 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002419
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002420 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2421 "server" keyword explanation below).
2422
2423server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002424 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002425 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2426 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2427 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2428 of this "peers" section).
2429 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2430
2431
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002432 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002433 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002434 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002435 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2436 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2437 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002438
2439 backend mybackend
2440 mode tcp
2441 balance roundrobin
2442 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2443 stick on src
2444
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002445 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2446 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002447
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002448 Example:
2449 peers mypeers
2450 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2451 default-server ssl verify none
2452 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2453 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002454
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002455
2456table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2457 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2458
2459 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2460 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002461 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002462 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2463 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2464 "stick-table" keyword).
2465
2466 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2467 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2468 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2469 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2470 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2471 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2472 of the stick-table name as follows:
2473
2474 peers mypeers
2475 peer A ...
2476 peer B ...
2477 table t1 ...
2478
2479 frontend fe1
2480 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2481
2482 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2483 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2484
2485 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2486 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2487 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2488 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2489 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2490 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2491 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2492
2493 peers mypeers
2494 peer A ...
2495 peer B ...
2496 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2497
2498 backend t1
2499 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2500
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002501 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002502 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2503 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2504
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025053.6. Mailers
2506------------
2507It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2508If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2509in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2510
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002511mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002512 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2513 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2514
2515mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2516 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2517
2518 Example:
2519 mailers mymailers
2520 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2521 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2522
2523 backend mybackend
2524 mode tcp
2525 balance roundrobin
2526
2527 email-alert mailers mymailers
2528 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2529 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2530
2531 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2532 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2533
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002534timeout mail <time>
2535 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2536 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2537 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2538 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2539
2540 Example:
2541 mailers mymailers
2542 timeout mail 20s
2543 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002544
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025453.7. Programs
2546-------------
2547In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2548master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2549managed the same way as the workers.
2550
2551During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2552sequence as a worker:
2553
2554 - the master is re-executed
2555 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2556 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2557 instance of the program
2558
2559During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2560
2561program <name>
2562 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2563 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2564 the management guide).
2565
2566command <command> [arguments*]
2567 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2568 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2569 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2570 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2571
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002572user <user name>
2573 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2574 See also "group".
2575
2576group <group name>
2577 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2578 See also "user".
2579
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002580option start-on-reload
2581no option start-on-reload
2582 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2583 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2584 program section.
2585
2586
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025873.8. HTTP-errors
2588----------------
2589
2590It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2591imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2592several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2593
2594http-errors <name>
2595 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2596 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2597
2598errorfile <code> <file>
2599 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2600
2601 Arguments :
2602 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002603 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2604 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002605
2606 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2607 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2608 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2609 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2610 before any chroot is performed.
2611
2612 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2613
2614 Example:
2615 http-errors website-1
2616 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2617 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2618 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2619
2620 http-errors website-2
2621 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2622 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2623 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2624
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026253.9. Rings
2626----------
2627
2628It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2629servers or traces.
2630
2631ring <ringname>
2632 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2633
2634description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002635 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002636 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2637
2638format <format>
2639 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2640
2641 Arguments:
2642 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2643 one of the following :
2644
2645 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2646 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2647 designed to be used with a local log server.
2648
2649 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2650 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2651 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2652 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2653 is the default.
2654
2655 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2656 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2657
2658 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2659 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2660
2661 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2662 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2663 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2664 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2665 logger consumes.
2666
2667 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2668 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2669 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2670 used with a local log server.
2671
2672maxlen <length>
2673 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2674 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2675 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2676
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002677server <name> <address> [param*]
2678 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2679 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2680 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2681 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2682 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2683 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2684 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2685 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2686 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002687 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2688 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002689
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002690size <size>
2691 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2692 set to BUFSIZE.
2693
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002694timeout connect <timeout>
2695 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2696
2697 Arguments :
2698 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2699 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2700 as explained at the top of this document.
2701
2702timeout server <timeout>
2703 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2704
2705 Arguments :
2706 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2707 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2708 as explained at the top of this document.
2709
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002710 Example:
2711 global
2712 log ring@myring local7
2713
2714 ring myring
2715 description "My local buffer"
2716 format rfc3164
2717 maxlen 1200
2718 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002719 timeout connect 5s
2720 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002721 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002722
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002725----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002727Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002728 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002729 - frontend <name>
2730 - backend <name>
2731 - listen <name>
2732
2733A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2734its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2735section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002737
2738A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2739connections.
2740
2741A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2742to forward incoming connections.
2743
2744A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2745parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002747All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2748'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2749case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2750
2751Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2752logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2753proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2754However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2755name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2756
2757Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2758and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002759bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002760protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2761modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2762arbitrary criteria.
2763
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002764In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2765a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002766the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002767
2768 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2769 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2770 between responses and new requests.
2771
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002772 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2773 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2774 client-facing connection remains open.
2775
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002776 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2777 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002778
2779The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2780frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2781following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002782weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002783
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002784 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002785
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002786 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2787 ----+-----+-----+----
2788 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2789 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002790 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2791 ----+-----+-----+----
2792 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027964.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2797--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002799The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2800limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2801they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2802limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002803marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002804option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002805and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2806with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2807specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002809
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002810 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2811------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2812acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002813backlog X X X -
2814balance X - X X
2815bind - X X -
2816bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002817capture cookie - X X -
2818capture request header - X X -
2819capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002820compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002821cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002822declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002823default-server X - X X
2824default_backend X X X -
2825description - X X X
2826disabled X X X X
2827dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002828email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002829email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002830email-alert mailers X X X X
2831email-alert myhostname X X X X
2832email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002833enabled X X X X
2834errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002835errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002836errorloc X X X X
2837errorloc302 X X X X
2838-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2839errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002840force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002841filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002842fullconn X - X X
2843grace X X X X
2844hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002845http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002846http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002847http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002848http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002849http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002850http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002851http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002852http-check set-var X - X X
2853http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002854http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002855http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002856http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002857http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002858http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002859id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002860ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002861load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002862log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002863log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002864log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002865log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002866max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002867maxconn X X X -
2868mode X X X X
2869monitor fail - X X -
2870monitor-net X X X -
2871monitor-uri X X X -
2872option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2873option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2874option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2875option allbackups (*) X - X X
2876option checkcache (*) X - X X
2877option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2878option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002879option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002880option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2881option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002882-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2883option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002884option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2885option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002886option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002887option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002888option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002889option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002890option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002891option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2892option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2893option httpchk X - X X
2894option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002895option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002896option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002897option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002898option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002899option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002900option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2901option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2902option logasap (*) X X X -
2903option mysql-check X - X X
2904option nolinger (*) X X X X
2905option originalto X X X X
2906option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002907option pgsql-check X - X X
2908option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002909option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002910option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002911option smtpchk X - X X
2912option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2913option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2914option splice-request (*) X X X X
2915option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002916option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002917option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2918option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2919-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002920option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002921option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2922option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2923option tcpka X X X X
2924option tcplog X X X X
2925option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002926external-check command X - X X
2927external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002928persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2929rate-limit sessions X X X -
2930redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002931-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002932retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002933retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002934server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002935server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002936server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002937source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002938stats admin - X X X
2939stats auth X X X X
2940stats enable X X X X
2941stats hide-version X X X X
2942stats http-request - X X X
2943stats realm X X X X
2944stats refresh X X X X
2945stats scope X X X X
2946stats show-desc X X X X
2947stats show-legends X X X X
2948stats show-node X X X X
2949stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002950-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2951stick match - - X X
2952stick on - - X X
2953stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002954stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002955stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002956tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002957tcp-check connect X - X X
2958tcp-check expect X - X X
2959tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002960tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002961tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002962tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002963tcp-check set-var X - X X
2964tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002965tcp-request connection - X X -
2966tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002967tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002968tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002969tcp-response content - - X X
2970tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002971timeout check X - X X
2972timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002973timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002974timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002975timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2976timeout http-request X X X X
2977timeout queue X - X X
2978timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002979timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002980timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002981timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002982transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002983unique-id-format X X X -
2984unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002985use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002986use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002987use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002988------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2989 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2993---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002994
2995This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2996
2997
2998acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2999 Declare or complete an access list.
3000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3001 no | yes | yes | yes
3002 Example:
3003 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3004 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3005 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003007 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008
3009
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003010backlog <conns>
3011 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3013 yes | yes | yes | no
3014 Arguments :
3015 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3016 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003017 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003018
3019 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3020 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3021 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3022 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3023 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3024 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3025 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3026 backlog parameter.
3027
3028 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3029 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3030 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3031
3032 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3033
3034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003036balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003037 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 yes | no | yes | yes
3040 Arguments :
3041 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3042 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3043 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3044 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3045
3046 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3047 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3048 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3049 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003050 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003051 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003052 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3053 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3054 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3055 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3056 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3057 it, so that you don't worry.
3058
3059 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3060 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3061 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3062 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3063 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3064 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3065 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3066 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003068 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3069 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3070 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3071 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3072 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3073 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3074 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3075 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3076
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003077 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003078 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003079 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3080 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003081 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003082 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3083 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3084 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3085 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3086 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003087 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3088 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3089 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3090 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3091 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3092 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003093
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3095 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3096 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3097 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3098 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3099 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3100 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3101 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003102 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003103 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003104 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3105 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3106 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003107
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003108 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3109 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3110 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3111 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3112 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3113 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3114 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3115 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3116 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3117 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3118 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3119 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003121 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003122 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3123 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3124 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3125 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3126 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3127 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3128 URIs start with a leading "/".
3129
3130 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3131 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3132 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3133 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003135 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003136 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3137
3138 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003139 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3140 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003141 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3142 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3143 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3144 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003145 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003146 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3147 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003148
3149 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3150 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3151 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3152 server will receive the request.
3153
3154 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3155 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3156 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3157 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3158 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003159 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3160 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3161 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003163 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3164 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3165 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3166 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3167 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003169 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003170 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3171 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3172 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3173
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003174 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3175 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3176 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3177
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003178 random
3179 random(<draws>)
3180 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003181 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3182 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3183 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3184 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003185 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3186 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3187 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3188 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3189 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3190 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3191 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3192 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3193 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3194 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3195 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3196 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3197 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3198 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3199 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3200 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3201 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3202 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3203 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3204 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003205
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003206 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003207 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003208 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3209 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3210 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3211 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3212 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3213 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003214 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003215 used instead.
3216
3217 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3218 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3219 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3220 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3221
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003222 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3223 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3224 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3225
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003226 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003227
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003228 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003229 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3230 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003231
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003232 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3233 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3234 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003235
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003236 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003237 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003238 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3239 NTLM relies on.
3240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241 Examples :
3242 balance roundrobin
3243 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003244 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003245 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3246 balance hdr(host)
3247 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003248
3249 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3250 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003252 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003253 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3254 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3255 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003256 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003257
3258 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3259 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3260 defaults to 16 kB.
3261
3262 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3263 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3264
3265 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3266 Round Robin.
3267
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003268 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003269 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3270 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3271 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3272
3273 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3274
3275 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003276 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003277 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3278 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3279 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003280
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003281 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003282
3283
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003284bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3285bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 no | yes | yes | no
3289 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003290 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3291 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3292 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3293 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003294 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003295 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3296 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3297 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3298 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3299 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3300 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3301 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003302 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3303 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3304 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3305 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3306 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3307 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3308 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003309 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3310 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3311 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003312 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3313 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3314 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3315 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003316 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3317 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3318 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003319
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003320 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3321 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003322 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3323 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3324 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003325 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3326 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3327 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3328 the range.
3329
3330 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3331 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3332 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3333 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3334 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3335 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3336 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003337 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003338 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003339
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003340 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003341 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003342 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3343 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3344 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3345 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3346 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3347 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3348
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003349 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3350 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3351 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3352 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3355 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3356 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3357 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3358 in a frontend.
3359
3360 Example :
3361 listen http_proxy
3362 bind :80,:443
3363 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003364 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003365
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003366 listen http_https_proxy
3367 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003368 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003369
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003370 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3371 bind ipv6@:80
3372 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3373 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3374
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003375 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003376 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003377
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003378 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3379 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3380 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3381 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3382 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3383
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003384 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003385 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003386
3387
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003388bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003389 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3391 yes | yes | yes | yes
3392 Arguments :
3393 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3394 may be used to override a default value.
3395
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003396 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003397 option may be combined with other numbers.
3398
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003399 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003400 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3401 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3402 missing from all processes.
3403
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003404 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003405 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003406 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3407 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3408 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3409 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3410 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003411 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003412
3413 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3414 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3415 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3416 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3417 and 'even' instances.
3418
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003419 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3420 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3421 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3422 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003423
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003424 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3425 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3426
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003427 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3428 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3429 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3430
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003431 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3432 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3433
3434 Example :
3435 listen app_ip1
3436 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003437 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003438
3439 listen app_ip2
3440 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003441 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003442
3443 listen management
3444 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003445 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003446
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003447 listen management
3448 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3449 bind-process 1-4
3450
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003451 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003452
3453
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454capture cookie <name> len <length>
3455 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3457 no | yes | yes | no
3458 Arguments :
3459 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3460 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3461 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3462 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003463 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003464
3465 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3466 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3467 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3468 right if it exceeds <length>.
3469
3470 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3471 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3472 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3473 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3474
3475 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3476 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3477 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3478
3479 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3480 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3481 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003482 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3483 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3484 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
3486 Example:
3487 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3488
3489 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003490 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491
3492
3493capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003494 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 no | yes | yes | no
3497 Arguments :
3498 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003499 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3501 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3502 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3503
3504 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3505 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3506 it exceeds <length>.
3507
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003508 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003509 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3510 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003511 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3512 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3513 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3514 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003515 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003516 environments to find where the request came from.
3517
3518 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3519 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3520 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3521 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003523 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3524 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3525 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3526 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3527 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
3529 Example:
3530 capture request header Host len 15
3531 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003532 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003534 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003535 about logging.
3536
3537
3538capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003539 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3541 no | yes | yes | no
3542 Arguments :
3543 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003544 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3546 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3547 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3548
3549 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3550 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3551 it exceeds <length>.
3552
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003553 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003554 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3555 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3556 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003557 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3558 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3559 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3560 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003561
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003562 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3563 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3564 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3565 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3566 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003567
3568 Example:
3569 capture response header Content-length len 9
3570 capture response header Location len 15
3571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003572 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003573 about logging.
3574
3575
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003576compression algo <algorithm> ...
3577compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003578compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003579 Enable HTTP compression.
3580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3581 yes | yes | yes | yes
3582 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003583 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3584 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3585 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3586
3587 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003588 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3589 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3590 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003591
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003592 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003593 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003594
3595 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3596 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3597 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3598 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3599 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003600 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003601
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003602 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3603 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3604 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3605 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3606 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3607 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3608 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003609 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003610
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003611 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003612 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003613 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3614 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3615 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3616 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3617 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003618
3619 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3620 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3621 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3622 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3623 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003624 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3625 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3626 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3627 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3628 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003629 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3630 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003631
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003632 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003633 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3634 "Accept-Encoding" header
3635 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003636 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003637 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3638 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3639 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3640 "multipart"
3641 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3642 header
3643 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3644 and later
3645 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3646 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003647 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003648
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003649 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003650
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003651 Examples :
3652 compression algo gzip
3653 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003654
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003655
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003656cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003657 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3658 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003659 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003660 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3662 yes | no | yes | yes
3663 Arguments :
3664 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3665 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3666 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3667 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3668 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3669 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003670 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3672 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3673
3674 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3675 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3676 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3677 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3678 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3679 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003680 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3681 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003682 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003683 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3684 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685
3686 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003687 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003688
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003689 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003690 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003691 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003692 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003693 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3694 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3695 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3696 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3697 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3698 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3699 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700
3701 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3702 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3703 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3704 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3705 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3706 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3707 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3708 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3709 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003710 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003711 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3712 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3713 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003714
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003715 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3716 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3717 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003718 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3719 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3720 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3721 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003722 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3723 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3724 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003725
3726 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3727 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3728 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3729 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3730 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3731 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3732 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3733 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3734 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3735
3736 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3737 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3738 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3739 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3740 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3741 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3742 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3743 persistence cookie in the cache.
3744 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3745
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003746 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3747 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3748 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3749 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3750 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003751 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003752 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3753 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3754 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3755 they logout.
3756
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003757 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3758 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3759 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3760 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3761
3762 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3763 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3764 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3765 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3766 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3767 this attribute.
3768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003769 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003770 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003771 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3772 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3773 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3774 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3775 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3776 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003777
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003778 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3779 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3780 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3781 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3782 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3783 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3784 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3785 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003786 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003787 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3788 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3789 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3790 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3791 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3792 the site.
3793
3794 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3795 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3796 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3797 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3798 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3799 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3800 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3801 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3802 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3803 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3804 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3805 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3806 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003807 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003808 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3809 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3810
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003811 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3812 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3813 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3814 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3815 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3816 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3817
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003818 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3819 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3820 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3821 repeated.
3822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003823 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3824 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3825 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3826 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003828 Examples :
3829 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3830 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3831 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003832 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003833
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003834 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003836
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003837declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3838 Declares a capture slot.
3839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3840 no | yes | yes | no
3841 Arguments:
3842 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3843
3844 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3845 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3846 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3847 for use in the response.
3848
3849 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003850 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003851 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3852
3853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003854default-server [param*]
3855 Change default options for a server in a backend
3856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3857 yes | no | yes | yes
3858 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003859 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3860 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3861 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3862 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003863
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003864 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003865 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3866
3867 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003868
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870default_backend <backend>
3871 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3873 yes | yes | yes | no
3874 Arguments :
3875 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3876
3877 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3878 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3879 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3880 will catch all undetermined requests.
3881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003882 Example :
3883
3884 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3885 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3886 default_backend dynamic
3887
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003888 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003889
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003890
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003891description <string>
3892 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3894 no | yes | yes | yes
3895 Arguments : string
3896
3897 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3898 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3899 it describes.
3900 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3901
3902
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003903disabled
3904 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3906 yes | yes | yes | yes
3907 Arguments : none
3908
3909 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3910 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3911 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3912 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3913 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3914 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3915 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3916
3917 See also : "enabled"
3918
3919
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003920dispatch <address>:<port>
3921 Set a default server address
3922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3923 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003924 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003925
3926 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3927 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3928 during start-up.
3929
3930 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3931 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3932 possible with normal servers.
3933
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003934 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003935 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3936 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3937 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3938 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3939
3940 See also : "server"
3941
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003942
3943dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3944 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3946 yes | no | yes | yes
3947 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3948
3949 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003950 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003951 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3952 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003953 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003954 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003956enabled
3957 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | yes | yes | yes
3960 Arguments : none
3961
3962 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3963 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3964
3965 See also : "disabled"
3966
3967
3968errorfile <code> <file>
3969 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3971 yes | yes | yes | yes
3972 Arguments :
3973 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003974 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003975 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003976
3977 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003978 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003979 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003980 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3981 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003982
3983 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3984 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3985 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3986
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003987 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3988
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02003989 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
3990 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
3991 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
3992 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
3993 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
3994 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
3995 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
3996 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
3997 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003999 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4000 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4001 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004002 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004003 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4004
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004005 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004007 Example :
4008 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004009 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004010 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4011 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4012
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004013
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004014errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4015 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4016 section.
4017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4018 yes | yes | yes | yes
4019 Arguments :
4020 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4021
4022 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004023 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004024 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004025
4026 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4027 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4028 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4029 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4030 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004031 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004032 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4033
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004034 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4035 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004036
4037 Example :
4038 errorfiles generic
4039 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4040
4041
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004042errorloc <code> <url>
4043errorloc302 <code> <url>
4044 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4046 yes | yes | yes | yes
4047 Arguments :
4048 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004049 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004050 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004051
4052 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4053 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4054 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4055 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004056 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004057
4058 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4059 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4060 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4061
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004062 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4063
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004064 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4065 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4066 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4067 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004068 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004069 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4070 request.
4071
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004072 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004073
4074
4075errorloc303 <code> <url>
4076 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4078 yes | yes | yes | yes
4079 Arguments :
4080 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004081 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004082 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004083
4084 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4085 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4086 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4087 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004088 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004089
4090 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4091 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4092 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4093
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004094 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4095
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004096 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4097 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4098 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4099 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004100 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004101
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004102 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004103
4104
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004105email-alert from <emailaddr>
4106 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004107 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | yes | yes | yes
4110
4111 Arguments :
4112
4113 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4114
4115 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4116 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4117
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004118 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004119 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4120 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004121
4122
4123email-alert level <level>
4124 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4125 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4126 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4127 yes | yes | yes | yes
4128
4129 Arguments :
4130
4131 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4132 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4133 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4134
4135 By default level is alert
4136
4137 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4138 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4139 for the proxy.
4140
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004141 Alerts are sent when :
4142
4143 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4144 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4145 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4146 is notice or lower
4147 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4148 and a health check status update occurs
4149
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004150 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4151 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004152 section 3.6 about mailers.
4153
4154
4155email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4156 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | yes | yes | yes
4159
4160 Arguments :
4161
4162 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4163
4164 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4165 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4166
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004167 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4168 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004169
4170
4171email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4172 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4173 mailers.
4174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4175 yes | yes | yes | yes
4176
4177 Arguments :
4178
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004179 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004180
4181 By default the systems hostname is used.
4182
4183 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4184 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4185 for the proxy.
4186
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004187 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4188 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004189
4190
4191email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004192 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004193 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4194 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4195 yes | yes | yes | yes
4196
4197 Arguments :
4198
4199 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4200
4201 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4202 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4203
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004204 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004205 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4206
4207
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004208force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4209 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4210 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004211 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004212
4213 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4214 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4215 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4216 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4217 marked down for maintenance operations.
4218
4219 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4220 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4221 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4222 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4223 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4224 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4225 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4226 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4227 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4228
4229 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4230 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4231 is used.
4232
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004233 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004234 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004235
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004236
4237filter <name> [param*]
4238 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4240 no | yes | yes | yes
4241 Arguments :
4242 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4243 referenced in section 9.
4244
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004245 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004246 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004247 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4248 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004249
4250 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4251 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4252
4253 Example:
4254 listen
4255 bind *:80
4256
4257 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4258 filter compression
4259 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4260
4261 compression algo gzip
4262 compression offload
4263
4264 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4265
4266 See also : section 9.
4267
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004268
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004269fullconn <conns>
4270 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 yes | no | yes | yes
4273 Arguments :
4274 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4275 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4276
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004277 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004278 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004279 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004280 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4281 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4282 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4283 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4284 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004285 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004286
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004287 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4288 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004289 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4290 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4291 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004292
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004293 Example :
4294 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4295 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4296 # connections.
4297 backend dynamic
4298 fullconn 10000
4299 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4300 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4301
4302 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4303
4304
4305grace <time>
4306 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004308 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004309 Arguments :
4310 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4311 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4312 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4313
4314 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4315 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004316 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004317 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4318
4319 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4320 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4321 simplify it.
4322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004324hash-balance-factor <factor>
4325 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 yes | no | no | yes
4328 Arguments :
4329 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4330 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004331 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004332
4333 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4334 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4335 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4336 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4337 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4338 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4339 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4340
4341 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4342 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4343 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4344 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4345 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4346
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004347 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4348 consistent hashing mechanism.
4349
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004350 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4351
4352
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004353hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004354 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 yes | no | yes | yes
4357 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004358 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4359 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004360
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004361 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4362 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4363 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4364 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4365 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4366 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4367 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4368 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4369 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4370 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004371
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004372 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4373 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4374 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4375 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4376 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4377 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4378 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4379 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4380 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4381 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4382 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4383 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4384 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004385 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4386 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004387
4388 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4389
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004390 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004391 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4392 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4393 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004394 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4395 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4396 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004397
4398 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4399 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004400 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4401 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4402 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4403 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4404
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004405 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4406 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4407 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4408 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4409 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4410 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4411 parameter.
4412
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004413 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4414 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4415 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4416 used on strings.
4417
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004418 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4419
4420 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4421 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4422 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4423 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4424 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4425 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4426 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4427 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4428 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4429 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4430 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4431 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004432
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004433 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4434 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4435 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004436
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004437 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004438
4439
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004440http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4441 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4442 ones).
4443
4444 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4445 no | yes | yes | yes
4446
4447 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4448 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4449 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4450 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4451 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4452 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4453
4454 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4455 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4456 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4457
4458 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4459 below.
4460
4461 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4462 instance.
4463
4464 Example:
4465 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4466 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4467 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4468
4469http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4470
4471 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4472 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4473 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4474 example, or to pass some internal information.
4475 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4476 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4477 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4478
4479http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4480
4481 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4482 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4483
4484http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4485
4486 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4487
4488http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4489 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4490
4491 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4492
4493 Example:
4494 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4495
4496 # applied to:
4497 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4498
4499 # outputs:
4500 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4501
4502 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4503
4504http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4505 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4506
4507 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4508
4509 Example:
4510 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4511
4512 # applied to:
4513 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4514
4515 # outputs:
4516 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4517
4518http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4519
4520 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4521 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4522 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4523
4524http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4525 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4526
4527 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4528 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4529 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4530 fallback.
4531
4532 Example:
4533 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4534 http-response set-status 431
4535 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4536 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4537
4538http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4539
4540 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4541 inline.
4542
4543 Arguments:
4544 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4545 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4546 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4547 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4548 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4549 (request and response)
4550 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4551 processing
4552 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4553 processing
4554 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4555 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4556 and '_'.
4557
4558 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4559 followed by some converters.
4560
4561 Example:
4562 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4563
4564http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4565
4566 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4567 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4568 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4569 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4570 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004571 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004572 processing.
4573
4574 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4575 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004576 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004577 rules evaluation.
4578
4579http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4580
4581 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4582 details about <var-name>.
4583
4584 Example:
4585 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4586
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004587
4588http-check comment <string>
4589 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4590 it fails.
4591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4592 yes | no | yes | yes
4593
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004594 Arguments :
4595 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4596 rule fails.
4597
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004598 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4599 user-friendly error reporting.
4600
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004601 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004602 "http-check expect".
4603
4604
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004605http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4606 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004607 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004608 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 yes | no | yes | yes
4611
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004612 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004613 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4614
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004615 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004616 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004617
4618 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4619 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4620 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4621 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4622
4623 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4624
4625 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4626
4627 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4628
4629 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4630
4631 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4632
4633 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4634 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4635 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4636 is used.
4637
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004638 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4639 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4640 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4641 haproxy -vv.
4642
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004643 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4644
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004645 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4646 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4647 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4648 different ports or with different servers.
4649
4650 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4651 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4652 the port with a "http-check connect".
4653
4654 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4655 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4656 do.
4657
4658 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4659 unset-var or comment rules.
4660
4661 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004662 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4663 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4664 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4665 option httpchk
4666
4667 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004668 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004669 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004670 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004671 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004672 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004673
4674 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4675
4676 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004677
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004679http-check disable-on-404
4680 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004682 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004683 Arguments : none
4684
4685 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4686 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4687 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4688 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4689 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4690 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4691 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4692 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004693 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4694 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4695 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4696
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004697 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004698
4699
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004700http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004701 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4702 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4703 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004704 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004706 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004707
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004708 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004709 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4710
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004711 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4712 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4713 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4714 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4715 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4716 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4717 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4718 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4719 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4720 result is always conclusive.
4721
4722 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4723 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4724 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004725 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4726 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4727 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4728 example 404 with disable-on-404
4729 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4730 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4731 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004732
4733 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4734 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004735 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4736 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4737 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4738 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4739 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4740 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004741
4742 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4743 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004744 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4745 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4746 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4747 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004748 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4749
4750 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4751 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4752 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4753 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4754
4755 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4756 informational message reported in logs if an error
4757 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4758 log-format string.
4759
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004760 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004761 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4762 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004763 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4764 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4765 details on the supported keywords.
4766
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004767 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4768 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4769 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4770 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004771
4772 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4773 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4774 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4775 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4776 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4777
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004778 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4779 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4780 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4781 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4782 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4783 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4784 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004785
4786 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004787 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004788 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4789 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4790 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4791 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4792
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004793 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4794 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004795 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4796 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4797 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4798 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4799 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4800 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4801 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4802 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004803 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4804 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4805 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4806 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4807 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4808 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4809 insensitive on the header names.
4810
4811 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4812 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4813 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4814 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4815 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4816 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004817
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004818 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004819 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004820 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4821 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4822 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4823 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4824 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004825 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004826 trace).
4827
4828 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004829 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004830 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4831 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4832 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4833 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4834 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004835 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004836
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004837 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4838 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4839 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4840 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4841 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4842 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4843
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004844 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4845 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4846 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4847 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4848 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4849 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4850 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4851 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4852
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004853 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4854 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4855 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4856 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4857 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004858
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004859 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4860 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4861
4862 Examples :
4863 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004864 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004865
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004866 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4867 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4868
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004869 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004870 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004871
4872 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004873 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004874
4875 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004876 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004877
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004878 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004879 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004880
4881
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004882http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004883 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4884 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004885 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4886 health checks.
4887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | no | yes | yes
4889 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004890 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4891
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004892 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4893 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4894 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4895 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4896 to invent non-standard ones.
4897
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004898 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4899 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4900 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4901 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4902
4903 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4904 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4905 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4906 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004907
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004908 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004909 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004910 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004911 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4912 to add it.
4913
4914 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4915 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4916 to the log-format rules.
4917
4918 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4919 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4920 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004921
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004922 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4923 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4924 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4925 request.
4926
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004927 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4928 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4929 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004930 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4931 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4932 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4933 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004934 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004935 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004936 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4937
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004938 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4939 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004940 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4941 so, it will be ignored.
4942
4943 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4944 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4945 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4946 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4947 configured request authority.
4948
4949 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4950 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004951
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004952 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004953
4954
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004955http-check send-state
4956 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4958 yes | no | yes | yes
4959 Arguments : none
4960
4961 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4962 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4963 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4964 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4965 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4966
4967 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4968 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4969 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4970 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4971 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004972 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4973 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4974 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4975
4976 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4977 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4978 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4979
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004980 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4981 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4982 checked in multiple backends.
4983
4984 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4985 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4986
4987 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4988 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4989 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4990 one fails.
4991
4992 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4993 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4994 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4995
4996 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4997 server's queue.
4998
4999 Example of a header received by the application server :
5000 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5001 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5002
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005003 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5004 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005005
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005006
5007http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005008 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 yes | no | yes | yes
5011
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005012 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005013 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5014 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5015 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5016 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5017 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5018 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5019 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5020 and '-'.
5021
5022 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5023
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005024 Examples :
5025 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005026
5027
5028http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005029 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005030 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5031 yes | no | yes | yes
5032
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005033 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005034 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5035 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5036 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5037 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5038 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5039 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5040 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5041 and '-'.
5042
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005043 Examples :
5044 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005046
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005047http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5048 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5049 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5050 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5051 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5053 yes | yes | yes | yes
5054 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005055 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005056 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005057 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5058 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005059
5060 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5061 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5062 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5063 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5064
5065 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5066 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5067 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5068 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5069
5070 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5071 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5072 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5073 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5074 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5075 chroot is performed.
5076
5077 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5078 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5079 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5080 considered.
5081
5082 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5083 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5084 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5085 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5086 considered as a raw string.
5087
5088 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5089 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5090 "content-type".
5091
5092 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5093 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5094 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5095 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5096 evaluated as a log-format string.
5097
5098 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5099 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5100 argument to "content-type".
5101
5102 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5103 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5104 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5105 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5106
5107 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5108 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5109 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5110 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5111 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5112 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5113 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5114 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5115
5116 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5117 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5118 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5119
5120 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5121 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5122
5123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005124http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005125 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5126
5127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5128 no | yes | yes | yes
5129
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005130 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5131 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5132 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5133 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5134 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005136 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5137 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005139 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005141 Example:
5142 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5143 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5144 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005146 http-request allow if nagios
5147 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5148 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5149 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005151 Example:
5152 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5153 acl add path /addacl
5154 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005156 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005158 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5159 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005161 Example:
5162 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5163 acl setmap path /setmap
5164 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005166 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005168 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5169 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005171 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5172 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005174http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005176 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5177 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5178 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5179 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5180 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5181 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5182 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5183 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005185http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005187 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5188 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5189 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5190 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5191 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5192 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5193 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5194 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005196http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005198 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5199 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005200
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005202http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005204 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5205 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5206 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5207 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5208 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005209
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005210 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5211 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5212 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5213 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5214 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5215 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5216 instead.
5217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005218 Example:
5219 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5220 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005221
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005222http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005223
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005224 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005226http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5227 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005229 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5230 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5231 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5232 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5233 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5234 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5235 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5236 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5237 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005239 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5240 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5241 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005242 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5243
5244 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5245 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5246 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5247 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005249http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005251 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5252 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5253 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5254 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5255 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5256 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005258http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005260 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005262http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005264 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5265 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5266 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5267 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5268 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5269 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005270
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005271http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5272http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5273 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5274 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5275 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5276 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005277
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005278 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5279 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5280 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005281 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005282 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5283 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5284 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005285 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005286 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005287
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005288http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5289 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5290 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5291 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5292
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005293http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5294
5295 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5296 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5297 pointed by <resolvers>.
5298 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5299 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5300 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5301 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5302 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5303 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5304 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5305 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5306 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5307 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5308 to 0.0.0.0.
5309
5310 Example:
5311 resolvers mydns
5312 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5313 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5314 timeout retry 1s
5315 hold valid 10s
5316 hold nx 3s
5317 hold other 3s
5318 hold obsolete 0s
5319 accepted_payload_size 8192
5320
5321 frontend fe
5322 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5323 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5324 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5325
5326 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5327 # which mean DNS resolution error
5328 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5329
5330 default_backend be
5331
5332 backend b_503
5333 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5334 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5335 # 503 error page to end users
5336
5337 backend be
5338 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5339 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5340 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5341 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5342 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5343
5344 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5345 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5346
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005347http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5348
5349 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5350 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5351 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5352 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005353 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5354 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005355
5356 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005358http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005360 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5361 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5362 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5363 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5364 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005366http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005368 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5369 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5370 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5371 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005373http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005375
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005376 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005377 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5378 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5379 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5380 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5381 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005382
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005383 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5384 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5385 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5386 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5387 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005388
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005389 Example:
5390 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5391
5392 # applied to:
5393 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5394
5395 # outputs:
5396 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5397
5398 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005399
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005400 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5401
5402 # applied to:
5403 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005404
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005405 # outputs:
5406 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005407
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005408http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5409 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5410
5411 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5412 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5413 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5414 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5415
5416 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5417 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5418 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5419
5420 Example:
5421 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5422 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5423
5424 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5425 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5426
5427 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5428 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5429 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5430 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5431
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005432http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5433 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5434
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005435 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5436 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5437 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5438 against.
5439
5440 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5441 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5442 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005443
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005444 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5445 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5446 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5447 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5448 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5449 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5450 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5451 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5452 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005453 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5454 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005455
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005456 Example:
5457 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5458 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005459
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005460 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5461 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005463http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5464 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005465
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005466 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5467 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5468 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5469 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005470
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005471 Example:
5472 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005473
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005474 # applied to:
5475 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005476
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005477 # outputs:
5478 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005479
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005480http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5481 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5482 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005483 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005484 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5485
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005486 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005487 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5488 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005489 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005490 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005491 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005492 are followed to create the response :
5493
5494 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5495 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5496 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5497 ignored.
5498
5499 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5500 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005501 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005502 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5503 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005504
5505 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5506 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5507 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005508 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005509 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005510
5511 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5512 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5513 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005514 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005515 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5516 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005517
5518 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5519 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5520 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5521 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5522 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5523 as a raw content.
5524
5525 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5526 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5527 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5528 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5529 considered as a raw string.
5530
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005531 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5532 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5533 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5534 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5535
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005536 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5537 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005538 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005539
5540 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5541
5542 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005543 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005544 if { path /ping }
5545
5546 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5547 if { path /favicon.ico }
5548
5549 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5550 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5551 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005553http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5554http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005556 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5557 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5558 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005559
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005560http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5561 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005562
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005563 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5564 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5565 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5566 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005568http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005570 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5571 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5572 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5573 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5574 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005576 Arguments:
5577 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5578 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005580 Example:
5581 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5582 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005584 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5585 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005587http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005589 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5590 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5591 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005593 Arguments:
5594 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5595 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005597 Example:
5598 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5599 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005601 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5602 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5603 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005605http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005607 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5608 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5609 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5610 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5611 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005613 Example:
5614 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5615 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5616 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5617 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5618 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5619 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5620 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5621 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5622 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005624http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005626 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5627 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5628 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5629 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5630 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005632http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5633 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005635 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5636 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5637 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5638 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5639 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5640 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5641 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5642 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5643 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005645http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005647 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5648 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5649 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5650 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5651 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5652 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5653 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005655http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005657 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5658 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5659 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005661http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005663 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5664 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5665 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5666 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5667 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5668 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5669 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5670 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005672http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005674 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5675 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5676 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5677 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5678 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5679 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005681 Example :
5682 # prepend the host name before the path
5683 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005685http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005687 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5688 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5689 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5690 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5691 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005693http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005695 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5696 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5697 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5698 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5699 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5700 values have higher priority.
5701 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5702 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5703 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5704 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5705 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005707http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005709 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5710 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5711 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5712 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5713 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5714 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5715 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005717 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005718
5719 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005720 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5721 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005723http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5724 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5725 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5726 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005727 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5728 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005729
5730 Arguments :
5731 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5732 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005733
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005734 See also "option forwardfor".
5735
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005736 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005737 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5738 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5739
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005740 # After the masking this will track connections
5741 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5742 http-request track-sc0 src
5743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005744 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5745 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5746
5747http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5748
5749 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5750 expression.
5751
5752 Arguments:
5753 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5754 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005755
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005756 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005757 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5758 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5759
5760 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5761 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5762 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5763
5764http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5765
5766 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5767 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5768 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5769 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5770 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5771 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5772 information from the request.
5773
5774 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5775
5776http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5777
5778 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5779 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5780 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5781 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5782 path and the query string.
5783 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5784
5785http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5786
5787 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5788 inline.
5789
5790 Arguments:
5791 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5792 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5793 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5794 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5795 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5796 (request and response)
5797 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5798 processing
5799 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5800 processing
5801 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5802 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5803 and '_'.
5804
5805 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5806 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005807
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005808 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005809 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005811http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5812 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005813
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005814 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5815 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5816 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5817 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5818 agent name must be used.
5819
5820 Arguments:
5821 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5822
5823 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5824 configuration.
5825
5826http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5827
5828 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5829 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5830 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5831 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5832 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5833 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5834 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5835 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5836 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5837 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5838 action.
5839 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5840 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5841 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5842 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5843 you fully understand how it works.
5844
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005845http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5846
5847 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5848 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5849 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5850 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5851 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005852 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005853 processing.
5854
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005855 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005856 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5857 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5858 rules evaluation.
5859
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005860http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5861http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5862 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5863 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5864 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5865 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005866
5867 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5868 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5869 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005870 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5871 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5872 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5873 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5874 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5875 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5876 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5877 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5878 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5879 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005880 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005881 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5882 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5883 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5884 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5885 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005886
5887http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5888http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5889http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5890
5891 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5892 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5893 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5894 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5895 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5896 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5897 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5898 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5899 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5900 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5901 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5902 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5903
5904 Arguments :
5905 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5906 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5907 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5908 select which table entry to update the counters.
5909
5910 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5911 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5912 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5913 that table until the session ends.
5914
5915 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5916 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5917 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5918 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5919 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5920 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5921 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5922 useful information.
5923
5924 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5925 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5926 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5927 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5928 checks that make use of it.
5929
5930http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5931
5932 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005933
5934 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005935 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005936
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005937http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5938
5939 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5940 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5941 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5942 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5943 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5944 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5945
5946 Arguments :
5947 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5948
5949 Example:
5950 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005952http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005953
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005954 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5955 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5956 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005957
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005959http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005960 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5961
5962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5963 no | yes | yes | yes
5964
5965 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5966 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5967 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5968 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5969 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5970 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005972 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5973 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005975 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005977 Example:
5978 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005980 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005982 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5983 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005985 Example:
5986 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005988 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005990 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5991 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005993 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5994 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005996http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005998 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5999 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6000 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6001 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6002 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6003 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6004 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6005 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006007http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006009 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6010 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6011 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6012 example, or to pass some internal information.
6013 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6014 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6015 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006017http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006019 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6020 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006021
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006022http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006023
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006024 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006026http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006028 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6029 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6030 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6031 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6032 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6033 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6034 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006036 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6037 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6038 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6039 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6040 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006041
6042 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6043 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6044 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6045 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006047http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006049 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6050 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6051 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6052 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6053 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6054 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006056http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006058 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006060http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006062 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6063 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6064 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6065 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6066 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6067 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006068
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006069http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6070http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6071 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6072 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6073 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6074 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006075
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006076 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6077 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6078 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006079 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006080 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6081 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6082 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006083 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006084 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006086http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006088 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6089 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6090 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6091 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6092 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6093 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006095http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6096 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006097
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006098 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6099 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006101 Example:
6102 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006104 # applied to:
6105 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006107 # outputs:
6108 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006110 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006112http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6113 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006114
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006115 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006116 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006118 Example:
6119 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006121 # applied to:
6122 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006124 # outputs:
6125 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006126
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006127http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6128 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6129 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006130 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006131 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6132
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006133 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006134 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6135 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006136 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006137 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006138 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006139 are followed to create the response :
6140
6141 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6142 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6143 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6144 ignored.
6145
6146 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6147 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006148 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006149 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6150 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006151
6152 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6153 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6154 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006155 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006156 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006157
6158 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6159 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6160 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006161 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006162 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6163 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006164
6165 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6166 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6167 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6168 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6169 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6170 as a raw content.
6171
6172 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6173 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6174 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6175 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6176 considered as a raw string.
6177
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006178 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6179 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6180 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6181 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6182
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006183 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6184 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006185 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006186
6187 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6188
6189 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006190 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006191 if { status eq 404 }
6192
6193 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6194 string "This is the end !" \
6195 if { status eq 500 }
6196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006197http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6198http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006200 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6201 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6202 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006203
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006204http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6205 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006206
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006207 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6208 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6209 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6210 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006212http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006214 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6215 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6216 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6217 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6218 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006219
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006220 Arguments:
6221 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006222
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006223 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6224 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006225
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006226http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006228 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6229 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6230 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006231
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006232http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6233
6234 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6235 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6236 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6237 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6238 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6239
6240http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6241
6242 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6243 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6244 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6245 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6246 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6247 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6248 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6249 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6250 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6251
6252http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6253
6254 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6255 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6256 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6257 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6258 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6259 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6260 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6261
6262http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6263
6264 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6265 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6266 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6267 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6268 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6269 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6270 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6271 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6272
6273http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6274 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6275
6276 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6277 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6278 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6279 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006280
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006281 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006282 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6283 http-response set-status 431
6284 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6285 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006287http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006289 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6290 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6291 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6292 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6293 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6294 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6295 based on some information from the request.
6296
6297 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6298
6299http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6300
6301 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6302 inline.
6303
6304 Arguments:
6305 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6306 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6307 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6308 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6309 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6310 (request and response)
6311 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6312 processing
6313 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6314 processing
6315 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6316 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6317 and '_'.
6318
6319 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6320 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006321
6322 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006323 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006325http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006327 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6328 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6329 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6330 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6331 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6332 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6333 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6334 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6335 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6336 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6337 action.
6338 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6339 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6340 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6341 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6342 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006343
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006344http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6345
6346 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6347 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6348 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6349 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6350 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006351 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006352 processing.
6353
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006354 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006355 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006356 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006357 rules evaluation.
6358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006359http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6361http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006362
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006363 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6364 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6365 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6366 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6367 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6368 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6369
6370http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6371
6372 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6373 about <var-name>.
6374
6375 Example:
6376 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6377
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006378
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006379http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6380 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6381
6382 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6383 yes | no | yes | yes
6384
6385 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006386 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6387 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6388 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006389
6390 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6391
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006392 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6393 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6394 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6395 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6396 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6397 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6398 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6399 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6400 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6401 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006402
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006403 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6404 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6405 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6406 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6407 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6408 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6409 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6410 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006411
6412 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6413 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6414 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6415 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6416 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6417 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6418 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6419 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006420 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006421 downsides of rare connection failures.
6422
6423 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6424 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6425 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6426 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6427 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6428 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006429 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006430 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6431 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6432 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6433 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6434 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6435
6436 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006437 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6438 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6439 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006440
6441 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006442 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006443
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006444 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6445 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006446
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006447 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006448
6449 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6450 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6451 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6452
6453 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6454
6455
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006456http-send-name-header [<header>]
6457 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006458 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6459 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006460 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006461 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6462
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006463 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6464 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6465 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6466 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6467 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6468 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6469 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6470 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6471 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6472 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6473 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6474 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6475 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6476 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6477 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6478 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006479
6480 See also : "server"
6481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006482id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006483 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6485 no | yes | yes | yes
6486 Arguments : none
6487
6488 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6489 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6490 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006491
6492
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006493ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6494 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6495 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006496 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006497
6498 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6499 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6500 and running).
6501
6502 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6503 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6504 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006505 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006506 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6507
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006508 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6509 "unless" condition is met.
6510
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006511 Example:
6512 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6513 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6514 ignore-persist if url_static
6515
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006516 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6517
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006518load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6519 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6520 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | no | yes | yes
6522
6523 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6524 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6525 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006526 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006527 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6528 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6529 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6530 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6531
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006532 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006533 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006534 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006535
6536 Arguments:
6537 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6538 named "server-state-file".
6539
6540 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6541 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6542 name is used as a file name.
6543
6544 none don't load any stat for this backend
6545
6546 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006547 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6548 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6549 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006550 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006551 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006552
6553 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6554 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6555
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006556 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006557
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006558 global
6559 stats socket /tmp/socket
6560 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006561
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006562 defaults
6563 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006564
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006565 backend bk
6566 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6567 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006568
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006569
6570 Then one can run :
6571
6572 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6573
6574 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6575
6576 1
6577 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6578 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6579 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6580
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006581 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006582
6583 global
6584 stats socket /tmp/socket
6585 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6586
6587 defaults
6588 load-server-state-from-file local
6589
6590 backend bk
6591 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6592 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6593
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006594
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006595 Then one can run :
6596
6597 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6598
6599 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6600
6601 1
6602 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6603 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6604 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6605
6606 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6607 "show servers state"
6608
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006609
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006610log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006611log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6612 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006613no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006614 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6616 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006617
6618 Prefix :
6619 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6620 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6621 prefix does not allow arguments.
6622
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006623 Arguments :
6624 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6625 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6626 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6627 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6628 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6629 parameter.
6630
6631 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6632 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6633
6634 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6635 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6636 standard syslog port).
6637
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006638 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6639 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6640 standard syslog port).
6641
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006642 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6643 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6644 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006645 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006646
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006647 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6648 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6649 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6650 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6651 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6652 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6653 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6654 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6655 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6656 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6657 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6658 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6659 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6660 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6661 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6662 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006663 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6664 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006665
6666 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6667 and "fd@2", see above.
6668
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006669 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6670 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6671 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6672 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6673 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6674 having the logs instantly available.
6675
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006676 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6677 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006678
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006679 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6680 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6681 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6682 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6683 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6684 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6685 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6686 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6687 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6688 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006689 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006690
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006691 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6692 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6693 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6694 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6695 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6696
6697 <sample_size>
6698 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6699 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6700 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6701 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6702 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6703
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006704 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6705 one of the following :
6706
6707 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6708 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6709
6710 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6711 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6712
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006713 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6714 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6715 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6716 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6717 systemd logger consumes.
6718
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006719 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6720 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6721 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6722 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6723
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006724 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6725
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006726 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6727 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6728 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6729
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006730 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6731 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6732 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6733 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006734
6735 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6736 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6737 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006738 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6739 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6740 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6741 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6742 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006743
6744 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6745
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006746 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6747 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6748 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006749
6750 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6751 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6752 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6753 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6754
6755 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6756 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006757
6758 Example :
6759 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006760 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6761 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6762 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006763 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6764 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006765 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006766
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006767
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006768log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006769 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6770 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6771 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006772
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006773 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6774 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6775 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6776 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6777 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006778
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006779 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6780 "option httplog" directives.
6781
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006782log-format-sd <string>
6783 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6785 yes | yes | yes | no
6786
6787 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6788 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6789 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6790 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6791 which covers the log format string in depth.
6792
6793 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6794 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6795
6796 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6797 log format to "rfc5424".
6798
6799 Example :
6800 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6801
6802
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006803log-tag <string>
6804 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6805 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6806 yes | yes | yes | yes
6807
6808 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6809 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6810 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6811 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6812 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6813 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6814 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6815 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6816 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006817
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006818max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6819 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6820 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6821 yes | no | yes | yes
6822
6823 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6824 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6825 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6826 servers.
6827
6828 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6829 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6830 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6831 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6832 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006833 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006834 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6835 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6836 picking a different server.
6837
6838 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6839 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6840 even if they have to be queued.
6841
6842 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6843 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6844
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006845max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6846 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6847 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6848 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006850maxconn <conns>
6851 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6853 yes | yes | yes | no
6854 Arguments :
6855 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6856 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6857 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6858 closes.
6859
6860 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6861 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6862 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6863 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006864 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6865 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6866 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6867 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006868
6869 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6870 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6871 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6872
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006873 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6874 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006876 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6877
6878
6879mode { tcp|http|health }
6880 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6882 yes | yes | yes | yes
6883 Arguments :
6884 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6885 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6886 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6887 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6888
6889 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6890 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6891 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6892 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6893 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6894
6895 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006896 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6897 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6898 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6899 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6900 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6901 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6902 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006903
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006904 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6905 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6906 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006907
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006908 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006909 defaults http_instances
6910 mode http
6911
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006912 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006914
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006915monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006916 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006919 Arguments :
6920 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6921 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006922 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006923 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6924 backend and its backup.
6925
6926 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6927 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6928 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6929 servers in a list of backends.
6930
6931 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6932 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6933 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6934 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6935 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6936 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6937 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006938 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6939 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006940
6941 Example:
6942 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006943 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006944 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6945 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6946 monitor-uri /site_alive
6947 monitor fail if site_dead
6948
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006949 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006950
6951
6952monitor-net <source>
6953 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6955 yes | yes | yes | no
6956 Arguments :
6957 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6958 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6959 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6960 followed by a mask.
6961
6962 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6963 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006964 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006965 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6966
6967 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6968 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6969 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6970 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006971 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6972 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6973 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006974
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006975 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6976 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6977 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6978 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6979 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6980 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006981
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006982 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6983 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006984
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006985 Example :
6986 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6987 frontend www
6988 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6989
6990 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6991
6992
6993monitor-uri <uri>
6994 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6996 yes | yes | yes | no
6997 Arguments :
6998 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6999 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7000
7001 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7002 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7003 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7004 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7005 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7006 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7007 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7008 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7009
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007010 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007011 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7012 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7013 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7014 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7015 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7016 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007017
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007018 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7019 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7020 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7021 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7022
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007023 Example :
7024 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7025 frontend www
7026 mode http
7027 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7028
7029 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
7030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007031
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007032option abortonclose
7033no option abortonclose
7034 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 yes | no | yes | yes
7037 Arguments : none
7038
7039 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7040 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7041 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7042 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007043 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007044 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7045 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7046 encountered while delivering the response.
7047
7048 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7049 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7050 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7051 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7052 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7053 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007054 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007055 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007056 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007057 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7058 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7059 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7060
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007061 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7062 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007063 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7064 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7065 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7066 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7067 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7068 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007069 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007070
7071 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7072 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7073
7074 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7075
7076
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007077option accept-invalid-http-request
7078no option accept-invalid-http-request
7079 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7081 yes | yes | yes | no
7082 Arguments : none
7083
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007084 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007085 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007086 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007087 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7088 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7089 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7090 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7091 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007092 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7093 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7094 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7095 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007096 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007097 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007098 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7099 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7100 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007101
7102 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7103 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7104 been confirmed.
7105
7106 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7107 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007108 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7109 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007110 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7111
7112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7114
7115 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7116 stats socket.
7117
7118
7119option accept-invalid-http-response
7120no option accept-invalid-http-response
7121 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 yes | no | yes | yes
7124 Arguments : none
7125
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007126 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007127 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007128 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007129 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7130 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7131 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7132 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7133 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007134 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7135 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7136 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007137
7138 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7139 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7140 been confirmed.
7141
7142 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7143 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7144 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7145 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7146
7147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7149
7150 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7151 stats socket.
7152
7153
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007154option allbackups
7155no option allbackups
7156 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7158 yes | no | yes | yes
7159 Arguments : none
7160
7161 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7162 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7163 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7164 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7165 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7166 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7167 order between the backup servers anymore.
7168
7169 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7170 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7171
7172 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7173 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7174
7175
7176option checkcache
7177no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007178 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7180 yes | no | yes | yes
7181 Arguments : none
7182
7183 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7184 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007185 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007186 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7187 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007188 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007189
7190 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007191 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007192 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007193 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7194 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007195 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007196 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007197 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7198 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007199 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007200 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7201 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007202 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007203 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7204 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7205 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7206 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7207 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7208 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7209 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7210 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7211 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7212
7213 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007214 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7215 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7216 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7217 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007218
7219 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7220 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007221 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007222 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007223
7224 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7225 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7226
7227
7228option clitcpka
7229no option clitcpka
7230 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 yes | yes | yes | no
7233 Arguments : none
7234
7235 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7236 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007237 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007238 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7239
7240 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7241 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7242 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7243 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7244
7245 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7246 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7247 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7248 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7249 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7250
7251 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7252
7253 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7254 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7255 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7256
7257 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7258 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7259
7260 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7261
7262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007263option contstats
7264 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7266 yes | yes | yes | no
7267 Arguments : none
7268
7269 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7270 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7271 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7272 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007273 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7274 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7275 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7276 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7277 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007278
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007279option disable-h2-upgrade
7280no option disable-h2-upgrade
7281 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7282 connection.
7283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7284 yes | yes | yes | no
7285 Arguments : none
7286
7287 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7288 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7289 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7290 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7291 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7292 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7293 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7294 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7295
7296 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7297 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007298
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007299option dontlog-normal
7300no option dontlog-normal
7301 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7303 yes | yes | yes | no
7304 Arguments : none
7305
7306 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7307 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7308 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7309 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7310 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7311 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7312 logged.
7313
7314 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7315 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7316 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007318 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007319 logging.
7320
7321
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007322option dontlognull
7323no option dontlognull
7324 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7326 yes | yes | yes | no
7327 Arguments : none
7328
7329 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7330 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7331 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7332 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7333 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7334 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007335 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7336 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7337 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007338
7339 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007340 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007341 would not be logged.
7342
7343 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7344 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7345
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007346 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7347 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007348
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007349
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007350option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007351 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7353 yes | yes | yes | yes
7354 Arguments :
7355 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7356 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007357 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007358 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007359
7360 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7361 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7362 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7363 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7364 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7365 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7366 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007367 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7368 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7369 possible that the client has already brought one.
7370
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007371 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007372 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007373 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007374 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007375 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007376 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007377
7378 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7379 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7380 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7381 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7382 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7383 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7384 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7385
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007386 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7387 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7388 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7389 are under the control of the end-user.
7390
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007391 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007392 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7393 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007394 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7395 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7396 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007397
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007398 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007399 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7400 frontend www
7401 mode http
7402 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7403
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007404 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7405 backend www
7406 mode http
7407 option forwardfor header X-Client
7408
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007409 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007410 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007411
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007412
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007413option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7414no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7415 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7417 yes | yes | yes | no
7418 Arguments : none
7419
7420 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7421 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7422 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7423 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7424 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7425 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7426 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7427
7428 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7429 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7430 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7431 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7432 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7433 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7434 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7435 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7436 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7437 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7438
7439 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7440
7441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7443
7444 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7445 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7446
7447
7448option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7449no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7450 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7452 yes | no | yes | yes
7453 Arguments : none
7454
7455 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7456 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7457 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7458 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7459 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7460 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7461 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7462
7463 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7464 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7465 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7466 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7467 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7468 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7469 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7470 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7471 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7472 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7473
7474 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7475
7476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7478
7479 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7480 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7481
7482
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007483option http-buffer-request
7484no option http-buffer-request
7485 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7487 yes | yes | yes | yes
7488 Arguments : none
7489
7490 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7491 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7492 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7493 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7494 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7495 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007496 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7497 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7498 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7499 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007500
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007501 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007502
7503
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007504option http-ignore-probes
7505no option http-ignore-probes
7506 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7508 yes | yes | yes | no
7509 Arguments : none
7510
7511 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7512 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7513 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7514 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7515 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7516 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7517 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7518 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7519 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007520 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7521 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007522 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7523
7524 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7525 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7526 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7527 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7528 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7529 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7530 are often the only way to detect them.
7531
7532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7534
7535 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7536
7537
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007538option http-keep-alive
7539no option http-keep-alive
7540 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7542 yes | yes | yes | yes
7543 Arguments : none
7544
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007545 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7546 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007547 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7548 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007549 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7550 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7551 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007552
7553 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7554 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007555 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7556 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7557 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7558 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7559 situations where this option may be useful :
7560
7561 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007562 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007563
7564 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7565 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7566
7567 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7568 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7569 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7570 request.
7571
7572 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7573 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007574 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7575 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7576 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007577
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007578 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7579 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7580 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7581 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7582 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7583 not set.
7584
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007585 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7586 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7587 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007588
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007589 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007590 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007591 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007592
7593
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007594option http-no-delay
7595no option http-no-delay
7596 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7598 yes | yes | yes | yes
7599 Arguments : none
7600
7601 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7602 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7603 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7604 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7605 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7606 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7607 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7608 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7609 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7610 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7611 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7612 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7613 affected.
7614
7615 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7616 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7617 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7618 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7619 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7620 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7621 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7622 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7623 latency environments.
7624
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007625 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7626
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007627
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007628option http-pretend-keepalive
7629no option http-pretend-keepalive
7630 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007632 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007633 Arguments : none
7634
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007635 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007636 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7637 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7638 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7639 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7640 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7641 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7642 consider the response complete.
7643
7644 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7645 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7646 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7647 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007648 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007649 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7650
7651 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7652 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7653 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7654 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7655 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7656 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7657 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7658
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007659 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7660 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7661 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7662 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7663 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7664 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007665
7666 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7667 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7668
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007669 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007670 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007671
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007672
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007673option http-server-close
7674no option http-server-close
7675 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7677 yes | yes | yes | yes
7678 Arguments : none
7679
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007680 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7681 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7682 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7683 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007684 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7685 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7686 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7687 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7688 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7689 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7690 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7691 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7692 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7693 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7694 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007695
7696 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7697 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7698 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7699 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007700 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7701 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007702
7703 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7704 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007705 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7706 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7707 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007708
7709 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7710 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7711
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007712 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7713 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007714
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007715option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007716no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007717 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7719 yes | yes | yes | no
7720 Arguments : none
7721
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007722 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007723 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7724 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7725 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7726 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7727 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7728 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7729
7730 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7731 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007732 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7733 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7734 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007735
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007736 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7737 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7738 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7739 front of an existing proxy.
7740
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007741 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7742
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007743 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007744
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007745option httpchk
7746option httpchk <uri>
7747option httpchk <method> <uri>
7748option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007749 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7751 yes | no | yes | yes
7752 Arguments :
7753 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7754 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7755 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7756 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7757 ones.
7758
7759 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7760 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7761 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7762
7763 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7764 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7765 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007766 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007767
7768 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7769 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7770 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7771 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7772 the lack of any response.
7773
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007774 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7775 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7776 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7777 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7778
7779 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7780 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7781 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007782
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007783 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7784 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007785 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007786 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007787 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007788
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007789 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7790 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7791 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7792 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7793
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007794 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007795 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7796 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7797 backend https_relay
7798 mode tcp
7799 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7800 http-check send hdr Host www
7801 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007802
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007803 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7804 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7805 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007806
7807
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007808option httpclose
7809no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007810 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7812 yes | yes | yes | yes
7813 Arguments : none
7814
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007815 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7816 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7817 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7818 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007819 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007820
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007821 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7822 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007823 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007824 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7825 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007826
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007827 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7828 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7829 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007830
7831 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7832 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007833 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7834 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7835 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007836
7837 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7838 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7839
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007840 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007841
7842
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007843option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007844 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007846 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007847 Arguments :
7848 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7849 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7850 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007851 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007852 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007853
7854 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7855 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7856 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7857 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7858 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7859 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7860 ports.
7861
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007862 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7863 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007864
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007865 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007867 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007868
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007869
7870option http_proxy
7871no option http_proxy
7872 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7874 yes | yes | yes | yes
7875 Arguments : none
7876
7877 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7878 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7879 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7880 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7881 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7882
7883 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7884 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007885 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7886 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007887
7888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7890
7891 Example :
7892 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7893 backend direct_forward
7894 option httpclose
7895 option http_proxy
7896
7897 See also : "option httpclose"
7898
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007899
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007900option independent-streams
7901no option independent-streams
7902 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7904 yes | yes | yes | yes
7905 Arguments : none
7906
7907 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7908 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7909 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7910 receive data or not.
7911
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007912 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007913 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7914 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7915 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7916 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7917 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7918 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7919 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7920 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7921 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7922 socket buffers.
7923
7924 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7925 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7926 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7927 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7928 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7929
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007930 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007931
7932
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007933option ldap-check
7934 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7936 yes | no | yes | yes
7937 Arguments : none
7938
7939 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7940 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7941 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7942 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7943
7944 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7945 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7946
7947 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7948 configure it.
7949
7950 Example :
7951 option ldap-check
7952
7953 See also : "option httpchk"
7954
7955
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007956option external-check
7957 Use external processes for server health checks
7958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7959 yes | no | yes | yes
7960
7961 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7962 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7963 command".
7964
7965 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7966
7967 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7968
7969
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007970option log-health-checks
7971no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007972 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 yes | no | yes | yes
7975 Arguments : none
7976
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007977 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7978 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7979 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007980
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007981 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7982 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7983 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7984 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7985 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7986
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007987 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007988 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007989
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007990 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7991 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7992 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007993
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007994
7995option log-separate-errors
7996no option log-separate-errors
7997 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7999 yes | yes | yes | no
8000 Arguments : none
8001
8002 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8003 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8004 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8005 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8006 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8007 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8008 provides very important information.
8009
8010 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8011 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8012 error logs.
8013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008014 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008015 logging.
8016
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008017
8018option logasap
8019no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008020 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8022 yes | yes | yes | no
8023 Arguments : none
8024
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008025 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8026 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8027 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8028 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8029
8030 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8031 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8032 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8033 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8034 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008035 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008036 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8037 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8038 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8039 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008040 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008041
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008042 Examples :
8043 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8044 mode http
8045 option httplog
8046 option logasap
8047 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8048
8049 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8050 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8051 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8052 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008054 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008055 logging.
8056
8057
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008058option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008059 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8061 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008062 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008063 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8064 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008065 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8066 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008067
8068 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8069 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008070 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008071 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8072 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8073 in the MySQL table, like this :
8074
8075 USE mysql;
8076 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8077 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8078
8079 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008080 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008081 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8082 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8083 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8084 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8085 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8086 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8087 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8088
8089 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8090 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008091
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008092 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008093
8094 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8095 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8096 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8097 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008098 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8099 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008100
8101 See also: "option httpchk"
8102
8103
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008104option nolinger
8105no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008106 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8108 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008109 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008110
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008111 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008112 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8113 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8114 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8115 connections.
8116
8117 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8118 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8119 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8120 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8121 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8122 this too.
8123
8124 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8125 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8126 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8127
8128 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8129 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8130 for servers.
8131
8132 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8133 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8134
8135
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008136option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8137 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8139 yes | yes | yes | yes
8140 Arguments :
8141 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8142 matching <network>
8143 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8144 header name.
8145
8146 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8147 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8148 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8149 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8150 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8151 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8152 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8153 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8154 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8155 possible that the client has already brought one.
8156
8157 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8158 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8159 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8160 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8161 header and requires different one.
8162
8163 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8164 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8165 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8166 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8167 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8168 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8169 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8170
8171 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8172 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8173 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8174 both are defined.
8175
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008176 Examples :
8177 # Original Destination address
8178 frontend www
8179 mode http
8180 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8181
8182 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8183 backend www
8184 mode http
8185 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8186
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008187 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008188
8189
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008190option persist
8191no option persist
8192 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8194 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008195 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008196
8197 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8198 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8199 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8200 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8201 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8202 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8203 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8204 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8205 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8206 redirected to another valid server.
8207
8208 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8209 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8210
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008211 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008212
8213
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008214option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8215 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 yes | no | yes | yes
8218 Arguments :
8219 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8220 PostgreSQL server.
8221
8222 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8223 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8224 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8225 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8226
8227 See also: "option httpchk"
8228
8229
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008230option prefer-last-server
8231no option prefer-last-server
8232 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 yes | no | yes | yes
8235 Arguments : none
8236
8237 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8238 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8239 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8240 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8241 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8242 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8243 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8244 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8245 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008246 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8247 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008248 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8249 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8250 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008251 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8252 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8253 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008254
8255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8257
8258 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8259
8260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008261option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008262option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008263no option redispatch
8264 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8266 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008267 Arguments :
8268 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8269 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8270 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008271 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008272 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008273 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008274 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8275 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8276 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8277
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008278
8279 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8280 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8281 be able to access the service anymore.
8282
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008283 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8284 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008285
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008286 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8287 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8288 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8289 following order:
8290
8291 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8292
8293 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8294 list, or
8295
8296 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8297
8298 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8299 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8300
8301 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8302 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8303 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8304 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8305
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008306 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008307 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8308 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8312
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008313 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008314
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008315
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008316option redis-check
8317 Use redis health checks for server testing
8318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8319 yes | no | yes | yes
8320 Arguments : none
8321
8322 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8323 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8324 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8325 find the "+PONG" response message.
8326
8327 Example :
8328 option redis-check
8329
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008330 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008331
8332
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008333option smtpchk
8334option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8335 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8337 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008338 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008339 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008340 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008341 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8342
8343 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8344 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8345 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8346
8347 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8348 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8349 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8350 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8351 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8352 dead server.
8353
8354 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8355 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008356 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008357 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8358
8359 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8360 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8361 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8362 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008363 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008364
8365 Example :
8366 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8367
8368 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008371option socket-stats
8372no option socket-stats
8373
8374 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8376 yes | yes | yes | no
8377
8378 Arguments : none
8379
8380
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008381option splice-auto
8382no option splice-auto
8383 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8385 yes | yes | yes | yes
8386 Arguments : none
8387
8388 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8389 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008390 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008391 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008392 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008393 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8394 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8395 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8396 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8397
8398 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8399 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8400 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8401 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8402 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8403 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8404 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8405 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8406 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8407 keyword.
8408
8409 Example :
8410 option splice-auto
8411
8412 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8413 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8414
8415 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8416 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8417
8418
8419option splice-request
8420no option splice-request
8421 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8423 yes | yes | yes | yes
8424 Arguments : none
8425
8426 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008427 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008428 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8429 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8430 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8431 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8432
8433 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8434
8435 Example :
8436 option splice-request
8437
8438 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8439 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8440
8441 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8442 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8443
8444
8445option splice-response
8446no option splice-response
8447 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8449 yes | yes | yes | yes
8450 Arguments : none
8451
8452 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008453 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008454 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8455 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8456 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8457 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8458
8459 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8460
8461 Example :
8462 option splice-response
8463
8464 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8465 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8466
8467 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8468 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8469
8470
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008471option spop-check
8472 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8474 no | no | no | yes
8475 Arguments : none
8476
8477 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8478 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8479 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8480 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8481
8482 Example :
8483 option spop-check
8484
8485 See also : "option httpchk"
8486
8487
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008488option srvtcpka
8489no option srvtcpka
8490 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8492 yes | no | yes | yes
8493 Arguments : none
8494
8495 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8496 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008497 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008498 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8499
8500 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8501 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8502 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8503 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8504
8505 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8506 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8507 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8508 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8509 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8510
8511 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8512
8513 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8514 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8515 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8516
8517 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8518 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8519
8520 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8521
8522
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008523option ssl-hello-chk
8524 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8526 yes | no | yes | yes
8527 Arguments : none
8528
8529 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8530 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8531 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8532 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8533 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8534 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8535 hello message.
8536
8537 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8538 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8539 messages, which is appreciable.
8540
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008541 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8542 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8543 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008544
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008545 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8546
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008547
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008548option tcp-check
8549 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8551 yes | no | yes | yes
8552
8553 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8554 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8555
8556 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8557 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8558 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8559
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008560 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008561 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8562 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8563 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8564 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8565 only.
8566
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008567 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008568 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8569 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8570 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8571 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8572
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008573 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008574 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8575 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008576 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008577 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8578 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8579 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8580 the respective protocols.
8581 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008582 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008583
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008584 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008585
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008586 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8587 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8588 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8589 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008590
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008591 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8592 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8593 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008594
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008595
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008596 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008597 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008598 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008599 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008600
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008601 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008602 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008603 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008604
8605 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8606 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008607 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008608 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008609 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008610 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008611 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008612 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008613 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8614 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008615 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008616 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8617 tcp-check expect string +OK
8618
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008619 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008620 (send many headers before analyzing)
8621 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008622 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008623 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8624 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8625 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8626 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008627 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008628
8629
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008630 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008631
8632
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008633option tcp-smart-accept
8634no option tcp-smart-accept
8635 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8637 yes | yes | yes | no
8638 Arguments : none
8639
8640 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8641 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8642 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8643 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8644 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8645 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8646
8647 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8648 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8649 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8650 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8651
8652 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8653 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8654 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008655 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008656
8657 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8658 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8659 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8660
8661 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8662 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8663 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8664
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008665 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8666
8667
8668option tcp-smart-connect
8669no option tcp-smart-connect
8670 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8672 yes | no | yes | yes
8673 Arguments : none
8674
8675 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8676 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8677 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8678 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8679 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8680
8681 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8682 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8683 complex.
8684
8685 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8686 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8687 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8688
8689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8691
8692 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8693
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008694
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008695option tcpka
8696 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8698 yes | yes | yes | yes
8699 Arguments : none
8700
8701 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8702 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008703 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008704 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8705
8706 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8707 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8708 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8709 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8710
8711 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8712 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8713 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8714 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8715 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8716
8717 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8718
8719 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8720 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8721 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8722 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8723 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8724 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8725 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8726 backends.
8727
8728 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8729
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008730
8731option tcplog
8732 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008734 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008735 Arguments : none
8736
8737 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8738 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8739 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8740 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8741 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8742 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8743 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8744 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8745
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008746 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008748 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008749
8750
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008751option transparent
8752no option transparent
8753 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008755 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008756 Arguments : none
8757
8758 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8759 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8760 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8761 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8762 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8763 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8764 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8765 appropriate server.
8766
8767 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8768 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8769
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008770 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008771 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008772
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008773
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008774external-check command <command>
8775 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8777 yes | no | yes | yes
8778
8779 Arguments :
8780 <command> is the external command to run
8781
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008782 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8783
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008784 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008785
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008786 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8787 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8788 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8789 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8790 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8791 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008792
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008793 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8794
8795 Environment variables :
8796 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8797 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8798
8799 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8800
8801 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8802
8803 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8804 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8805 for a UNIX socket).
8806
8807 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8808
8809 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8810
8811 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8812
8813 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8814
8815 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8816
8817 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8818 socket).
8819
8820 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8821 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8822
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008823 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8824
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008825 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8826 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8827 failed.
8828
8829 Example :
8830 external-check command /bin/true
8831
8832 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8833
8834
8835external-check path <path>
8836 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8838 yes | no | yes | yes
8839
8840 Arguments :
8841 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8842
8843 The default path is "".
8844
8845 Example :
8846 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8847
8848 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8849 "external-check command"
8850
8851
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008852persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008853persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008854 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8856 yes | no | yes | yes
8857 Arguments :
8858 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008859 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8860 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008861
8862 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8863 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008864 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008865 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8866 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8867 forwarded to this server.
8868
8869 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8870 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8871 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008872 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008873 a single "listen" section.
8874
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008875 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8876 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8877 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8878
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008879 Example :
8880 listen tse-farm
8881 bind :3389
8882 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8883 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8884 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8885 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8886 persist rdp-cookie
8887 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008888 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008889 balance rdp-cookie
8890 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8891 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8892
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008893 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8894 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008895
8896
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008897rate-limit sessions <rate>
8898 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8900 yes | yes | yes | no
8901 Arguments :
8902 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8903 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8904
8905 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8906 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8907 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8908 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8909 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8910 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8911
8912 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8913 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8914 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8915 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8916
8917 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8918 listen smtp
8919 mode tcp
8920 bind :25
8921 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008922 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008923
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008924 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8925 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8926 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008927
8928 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8929
8930
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008931redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8932redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8933redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008934 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8936 no | yes | yes | yes
8937
8938 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008939 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008940
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008941 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008942 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008943 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8944 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8945 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008946
8947 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8948 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8949 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8950 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8951 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008952 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8953 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8954 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8955 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008956
8957 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8958 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8959 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8960 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8961 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8962 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008963 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008964 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008965 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8966 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8967 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008968
8969 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008970 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8971 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8972 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008973 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008974 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8975 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8976 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8977 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008978
8979 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008980 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008981
8982 - "drop-query"
8983 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8984 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8985 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8986 with a location-type redirect.
8987
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008988 - "append-slash"
8989 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8990 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8991 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8992 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8993
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008994 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8995 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8996 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8997 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8998 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8999 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9000 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9001
9002 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9003 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9004 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9005 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9006 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9007 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9008 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009009
9010 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9011 acl clear dst_port 80
9012 acl secure dst_port 8080
9013 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009014 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009015 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009016 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9017
9018 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009019 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9020 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9021 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009022 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009023
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009024 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9025 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9026 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9027
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009028 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009029 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009030
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009031 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009032 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9033 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9034 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009036 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009037
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009038
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009039retries <value>
9040 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9042 yes | no | yes | yes
9043 Arguments :
9044 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9045 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9046 default value is 3.
9047
9048 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9049 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9050 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9051
9052 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009053 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9054 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009055
9056 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9057 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9058
9059 See also : "option redispatch"
9060
9061
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009062retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009063 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9064 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9065 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009066 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9067 yes | no | yes | yes
9068 Arguments :
9069 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9070 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9071 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9072 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9073
9074 none never retry
9075
9076 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9077 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9078
9079 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9080 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9081 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9082 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9083 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9084 processing the request.
9085
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009086 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9087 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9088 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9089 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9090 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9091 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9092 overflow attack for example).
9093
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009094 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9095 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9096 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9097 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9098 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9099 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9100 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9101 amplify denial of service attacks.
9102
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009103 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9104 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9105 considered to be safe to retry.
9106
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009107 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9108 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9109 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9110 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9111
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009112 all-retryable-errors
9113 retry request for any error that are considered
9114 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9115 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9116 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9117
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009118 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9119 not cumulative.
9120
9121 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9122 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9123 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9124 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9125
9126 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9127 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9128 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9129 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9130 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9131 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9132 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9133 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9134 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9135 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9136 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9137 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9138
9139 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9140 should not use this directive.
9141
9142 The default is "conn-failure".
9143
9144 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9145
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009146server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009147 Declare a server in a backend
9148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9149 no | no | yes | yes
9150 Arguments :
9151 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009152 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009153 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009154
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009155 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9156 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9157 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9158 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009159 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9160 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9161 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9162 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9163 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009164 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9165 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9166 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9167 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9168 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9169 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9170 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009171 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009172 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9173 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9174 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9175 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9176 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9177 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009178 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9179 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009180 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9181 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009182
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009183 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009184 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9185 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9186 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9187 adding this value to the client's port.
9188
9189 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9190 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009191 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009192
9193 Examples :
9194 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9195 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009196 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009197 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9198 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9199 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009200
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009201 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9202 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9203 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9204 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9205 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9206
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009207 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9208 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009209
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009210server-state-file-name [<file>]
9211 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9212 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9213 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9214 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9215 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9216 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9217
9218 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9219 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9220
9221 global
9222 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9223
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009224 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009225 load-server-state-from-file
9226
9227 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9228 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009229
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009230server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9231 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9232 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9234 no | no | yes | yes
9235
9236 Arguments:
9237 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9238
9239 <num | range>
9240 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9241 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9242 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9243 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9244
9245 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9246
9247 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9248
9249 <params*>
9250 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9251 keyword.
9252
9253 Examples:
9254 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9255 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9256 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9257
9258 # or
9259 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9260
9261 # would be equivalent to:
9262 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9263 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9264 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9265
9266
9267
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009268source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009269source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009270source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009271 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9273 yes | no | yes | yes
9274 Arguments :
9275 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9276 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009277
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009278 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009279 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9280 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9281 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9282 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9283 supported prefixes are :
9284 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9285 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9286 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009287 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009288 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9289 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009290
9291 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9292 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009293 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9294 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9295 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009296
9297 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9298 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9299 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9300 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9301 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9302 <addr>.
9303
9304 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9305 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9306 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9307 port.
9308
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009309 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9310 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9311 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9312 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009313 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009314 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9315 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9316 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9317 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9318 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9319 HTTP header.
9320
9321 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9322 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009323 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009324 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9325 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9326 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9327 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9328 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9329 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9330 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9331
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009332 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9333 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9334 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9335 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9336 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9337 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9338
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009339 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9340 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9341 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9342 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9343
9344 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9345 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9346 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9347 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9348 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9349 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9350
9351 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9352 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9353 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9354 there are two methods :
9355
9356 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9357 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9358 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9359 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9360 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9361 of the client ranges may be used.
9362
9363 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9364 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9365 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9366 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9367 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9368 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9369 same session.
9370
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009371 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9372 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9373 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009374 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009375
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009376 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9377
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009378 Examples :
9379 backend private
9380 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9381 source 192.168.1.200
9382
9383 backend transparent_ssl1
9384 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9385 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9386
9387 backend transparent_ssl2
9388 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9389 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9390 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9391
9392 backend transparent_ssl3
9393 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9394 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9395 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9396
9397 backend transparent_smtp
9398 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9399 # with Tproxy version 4.
9400 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9401
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009402 backend transparent_http
9403 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9404 # proxy.
9405 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009407 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009408 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9409
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009410
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009411stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9412 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009414 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009415
9416 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9417 matched.
9418
9419 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9420 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9421
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009422 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9423 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009424 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009425
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009426 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9427 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9428 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9429 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009430
9431 Example :
9432 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9433 backend stats_localhost
9434 stats enable
9435 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9436
9437 Example :
9438 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9439 backend stats_auth
9440 stats enable
9441 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9442 stats admin if TRUE
9443
9444 Example :
9445 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9446 userlist stats-auth
9447 group admin users admin
9448 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9449 group readonly users haproxy
9450 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9451
9452 backend stats_auth
9453 stats enable
9454 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9455 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9456 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9457 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9458
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009459 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9460 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9461 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009462
9463
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009464stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9465 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009467 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009468 Arguments :
9469 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9470
9471 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9472
9473 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9474 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9475 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9476 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9477 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9478 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9479
9480 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9481 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9482 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009483 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009484
9485 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9486 report using "stats scope".
9487
9488 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9489 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9490 unobvious parameters.
9491
9492 Example :
9493 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9494 backend public_www
9495 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9496 stats enable
9497 stats hide-version
9498 stats scope .
9499 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009500 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009501 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9502 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9503
9504 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9505 backend private_monitoring
9506 stats enable
9507 stats uri /admin?stats
9508 stats refresh 5s
9509
9510 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9511
9512
9513stats enable
9514 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009516 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009517 Arguments : none
9518
9519 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9520 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9521 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9522 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9523 - stats auth : no authentication
9524 - stats scope : no restriction
9525
9526 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9527 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9528 unobvious parameters.
9529
9530 Example :
9531 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9532 backend public_www
9533 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9534 stats enable
9535 stats hide-version
9536 stats scope .
9537 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009538 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009539 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9540 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9541
9542 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9543 backend private_monitoring
9544 stats enable
9545 stats uri /admin?stats
9546 stats refresh 5s
9547
9548 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9549
9550
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009551stats hide-version
9552 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009554 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009555 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009556
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009557 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9558 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9559 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9560 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9561 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9562 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009564 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9565 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9566 unobvious parameters.
9567
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009568 Example :
9569 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9570 backend public_www
9571 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009572 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009573 stats hide-version
9574 stats scope .
9575 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009576 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009577 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9578 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009579
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009580 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9581 backend private_monitoring
9582 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009583 stats uri /admin?stats
9584 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009585
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009586 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009587
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009588
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009589stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9590 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9591 Access control for statistics
9592
9593 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9594 no | no | yes | yes
9595
9596 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9597 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9598 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9599 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9600 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9601 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9602
9603 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9604 instance.
9605
9606 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9607 about ACL usage.
9608
9609
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009610stats realm <realm>
9611 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009613 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009614 Arguments :
9615 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9616 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9617 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9618
9619 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9620 using a backslash ('\').
9621
9622 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9623 only related to authentication.
9624
9625 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9626 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9627 unobvious parameters.
9628
9629 Example :
9630 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9631 backend public_www
9632 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9633 stats enable
9634 stats hide-version
9635 stats scope .
9636 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009637 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009638 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9639 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9640
9641 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9642 backend private_monitoring
9643 stats enable
9644 stats uri /admin?stats
9645 stats refresh 5s
9646
9647 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9648
9649
9650stats refresh <delay>
9651 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009653 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009654 Arguments :
9655 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9656 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9657 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9658 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9659 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9660 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9661
9662 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9663 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9664 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9665 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9666
9667 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9668 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9669 unobvious parameters.
9670
9671 Example :
9672 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9673 backend public_www
9674 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9675 stats enable
9676 stats hide-version
9677 stats scope .
9678 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009679 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009680 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9681 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9682
9683 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9684 backend private_monitoring
9685 stats enable
9686 stats uri /admin?stats
9687 stats refresh 5s
9688
9689 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9690
9691
9692stats scope { <name> | "." }
9693 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009695 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009696 Arguments :
9697 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9698 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9699 section in which the statement appears.
9700
9701 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9702 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9703 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9704 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9705 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9706 exists.
9707
9708 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9709 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9710 unobvious parameters.
9711
9712 Example :
9713 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9714 backend public_www
9715 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9716 stats enable
9717 stats hide-version
9718 stats scope .
9719 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009720 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009721 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9722 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9723
9724 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9725 backend private_monitoring
9726 stats enable
9727 stats uri /admin?stats
9728 stats refresh 5s
9729
9730 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9731
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009732
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009733stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009734 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009736 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009737
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009738 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009739 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9740
9741 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9742 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9743
9744 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9745 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009747
9748 Example :
9749 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9750 backend private_monitoring
9751 stats enable
9752 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9753 stats uri /admin?stats
9754 stats refresh 5s
9755
9756 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9757 global section.
9758
9759
9760stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009761 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9763 yes | yes | yes | yes
9764 Arguments : none
9765
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009766 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009767 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9768 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9769 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9770 - IP (socket, server)
9771 - cookie (backend, server)
9772
9773 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9774 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009775 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009776
9777 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9778
9779
9780stats show-node [ <name> ]
9781 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009783 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009784 Arguments:
9785 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9786 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9787
9788 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9789 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009790 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009791
9792 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9793 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9794 unobvious parameters.
9795
9796 Example:
9797 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9798 backend private_monitoring
9799 stats enable
9800 stats show-node Europe-1
9801 stats uri /admin?stats
9802 stats refresh 5s
9803
9804 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9805 section.
9806
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009807
9808stats uri <prefix>
9809 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009811 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009812 Arguments :
9813 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9814 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9815 query string.
9816
9817 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9818 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9819 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9820 possible to reach it in the application.
9821
9822 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009823 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009824 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9825 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9826 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9827 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9828
9829 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9830 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9831 an address or a port to statistics only.
9832
9833 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9834 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9835 unobvious parameters.
9836
9837 Example :
9838 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9839 backend public_www
9840 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9841 stats enable
9842 stats hide-version
9843 stats scope .
9844 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009845 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009846 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9847 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9848
9849 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9850 backend private_monitoring
9851 stats enable
9852 stats uri /admin?stats
9853 stats refresh 5s
9854
9855 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9856
9857
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009858stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9859 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009861 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009862
9863 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009864 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009865 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009866 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009867 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9868
9869 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9870 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9871 the "stick-table" statement.
9872
9873 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9874 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9875 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9876 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9877 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9878
9879 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9880 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9881 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9882 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9883 transformation rules.
9884
9885 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9886 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9887 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9888 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9889 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9890 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9891 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9892
9893 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9894 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9895 ACL based conditions.
9896
9897 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9898 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9899 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9900 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9901
9902 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9903 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9904 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9905 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9906
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009907 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9908 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009909 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009910
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009911 Example :
9912 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9913 # last 30 minutes
9914 backend pop
9915 mode tcp
9916 balance roundrobin
9917 stick store-request src
9918 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9919 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9920 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9921
9922 backend smtp
9923 mode tcp
9924 balance roundrobin
9925 stick match src table pop
9926 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9927 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9928
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009929 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009930 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009931
9932
9933stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9934 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9936 no | no | yes | yes
9937
9938 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9939 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9940 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9941 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9942
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009943 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9944 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009945 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009946
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009947 Examples :
9948 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009949 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009950
9951 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9952 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9953 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9954
9955
9956 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9957 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9958 backend http
9959 mode http
9960 balance roundrobin
9961 stick on src table https
9962 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9963 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9964 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9965
9966 backend https
9967 mode tcp
9968 balance roundrobin
9969 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9970 stick on src
9971 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9972 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9973
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009974 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009975
9976
9977stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9978 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9980 no | no | yes | yes
9981
9982 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009983 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009984 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009985 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009986 server is selected.
9987
9988 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9989 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9990 the "stick-table" statement.
9991
9992 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9993 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9994 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9995 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9996 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9997 address.
9998
9999 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10000 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10001 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10002 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10003 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10004 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10005 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10006 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10007 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10008 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10009
10010 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10011 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10012 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10013 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10014 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10015 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10016 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10017
10018 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10019 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10020 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10021 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10022
10023 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10024 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10025 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10026 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10027 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10028 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010029 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10030 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10031 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10032 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10033 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10034 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010035
10036 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10037 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10038 the request.
10039
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010040 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10041 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010042 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010043
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010044 Example :
10045 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10046 # last 30 minutes
10047 backend pop
10048 mode tcp
10049 balance roundrobin
10050 stick store-request src
10051 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10052 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10053 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10054
10055 backend smtp
10056 mode tcp
10057 balance roundrobin
10058 stick match src table pop
10059 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10060 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10061
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010062 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010063 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010064
10065
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010066stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010067 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10068 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010069 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010071 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010072
10073 Arguments :
10074 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10075 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10076 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10077 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10078
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010079 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10080 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10081 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10082 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10083
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010084 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10085 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10086 instance.
10087
10088 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10089 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10090 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10091 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10092 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10093 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010094 to 32 characters.
10095
10096 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10097 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10098 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010099 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010100 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10101 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010102
10103 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010104 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10105 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010106 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10107 increase.
10108
10109 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010110 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10111 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10112 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010113
10114 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10115 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10116 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10117 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010118 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010119 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10120 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10121 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10122 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10123 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10124 parameter (see below).
10125
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010126 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10127 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10128 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10129 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10130 soft restart.
10131
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010132 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10133 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010134
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010135 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10136 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10137 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10138 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010139 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010140 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010141 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10142 if not expiration delay is specified.
10143
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010144 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10145 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10146 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10147 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010148 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10149 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10150 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10151 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10152 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10153 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10154 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10155 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10156 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10157 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10158 types and their arguments.
10159
10160 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10161 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10162 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10163 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10164
10165 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10166 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10167 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010168 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010169
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010170 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10171 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10172 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010173 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010174 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010175 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010176
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010177 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10178 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10179 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10180 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10181
10182 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10183 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10184 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10185 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10186 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10187 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10188
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010189 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10190 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10191 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10192 they were received.
10193
10194 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10195 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10196 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10197 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10198 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10199
10200 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10201 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10202 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10203 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10204 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10205
10206 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10207 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10208 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10209
10210 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10211 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10212 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10213 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10214 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10215
10216 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10217 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10218 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10219 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10220 the client side.
10221
10222 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10223 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10224 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10225 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10226 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10227 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10228 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10229
10230 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10231 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10232 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10233 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10234 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10235 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010236 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010237
10238 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10239 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10240 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10241 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10242 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10243 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10244
10245 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010246 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010247 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10248 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10249
10250 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10251 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10252 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10253 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10254 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10255 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10256 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10257 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10258 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10259 recommended for better fairness.
10260
10261 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010262 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010263 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10264 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10265
10266 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10267 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10268 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10269 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10270 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10271 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10272 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10273 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10274 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10275 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010276
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010277 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10278 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010279 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10280 reference it.
10281
10282 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10283 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010284 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10285 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10286 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010287
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010288 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10289 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10290 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10291 something that can be ignored.
10292
10293 Example:
10294 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10295 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10296 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10297 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10298
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010299 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010300 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010301
10302
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010303stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010304 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10306 no | no | yes | yes
10307
10308 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010309 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010310 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010311 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010312 server is selected.
10313
10314 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10315 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10316 the "stick-table" statement.
10317
10318 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10319 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10320 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10321 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10322
10323 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10324 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10325 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10326 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10327 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10328 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010329 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010330 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10331 rules.
10332
10333 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10334 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10335 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10336 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10337 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10338 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10339 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10340
10341 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10342 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10343 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10344 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10345
10346 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10347 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10348 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10349 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10350 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10351 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010352 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10353 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10354 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10355 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10356 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10357 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10358 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10359 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10360 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010361
10362 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10363
10364 Example :
10365 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10366 backend https
10367 mode tcp
10368 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010369 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010370 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010371
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010372 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10373 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10374
10375 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10376 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10377 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10378
10379 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10380 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010381
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010382 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10383 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10384 # at offset 44.
10385
10386 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10387 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10388
10389 # Learn on response if server hello.
10390 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010391
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010392 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10393 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10394
10395 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10396 extraction.
10397
10398
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010399tcp-check comment <string>
10400 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10401 it fails.
10402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10403 yes | no | yes | yes
10404
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010405 Arguments :
10406 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10407 rule fails.
10408
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010409 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10410 user-friendly error reporting.
10411
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010412 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10413 "tcp-check expect".
10414
10415
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010416tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10417 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010418 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010419 Opens a new connection
10420 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010421 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010422
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010423 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010424 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10425
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010426 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010427 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010428
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010429 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010430 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10431 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010432 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010433
10434 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010435
10436 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10437
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010438 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10439
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010440 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10441
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010442 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10443
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010444 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10445 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10446 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10447 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10448
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010449 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10450 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10451 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10452 haproxy -vv.
10453
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010454 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010455
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010456 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10457 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10458 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10459
10460 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10461 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10462 of the sequence.
10463
10464 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10465 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10466 do.
10467
10468 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10469 unset-var or comment rules.
10470
10471 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010472 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10473 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10474 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10475 option tcp-check
10476 tcp-check connect
10477 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10478 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10479 tcp-check send \r\n
10480 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10481 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10482 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10483 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10484 tcp-check send \r\n
10485 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10486 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10487
10488 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10489 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010490 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010491 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10492 tcp-check connect port 143
10493 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10494 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10495
10496 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10497
10498
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010499tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010500 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010501 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010502 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010503 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010504 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010505 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010506
10507 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010508 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10509
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010510 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10511 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10512 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10513 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10514 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10515 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10516 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10517 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10518 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10519 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10520
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010521 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010522 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10523 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010524 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10525 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10526 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10527
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010528 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10529 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10530 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010531 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10532 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10533 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10534 example 404 with disable-on-404
10535 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10536 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010537 By default "L7OK" is used.
10538
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010539 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10540 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010541 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10542 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10543 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10544 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10545 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10546 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010547
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010548 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010549 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010550 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10551 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10552 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10553 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010554 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10555
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010556 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10557 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10558 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10559 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10560
10561 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10562 informational message reported in logs if an error
10563 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10564 log-format string.
10565
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010566 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10567 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10568 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10569 followed by some converters.
10570
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010571 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10572 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10573 with the usual backslash ('\').
10574 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010575 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010576 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10577 used upper or lower case.
10578
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010579 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10580
10581 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10582 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10583 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10584 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10585 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10586 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10587 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10588 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10589
10590 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10591 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10592 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10593 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10594 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10595 expression.
10596
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010597 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10598 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10599 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10600 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10601 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10602 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10603
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010604 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10605 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10606 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10607 this exact hexadecimal string.
10608 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10609
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010610 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10611 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10612 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10613 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10614 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10615 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10616 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10617 size.
10618
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010619 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10620 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10621 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10622 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10623 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10624 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10625 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10626 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10627 in a binary string before matching the response's
10628 buffer.
10629
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010630 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10631 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10632 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10633 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10634 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10635 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10636 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10637 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10638 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10639 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10640 the null character.
10641
10642 Examples :
10643 # perform a POP check
10644 option tcp-check
10645 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10646
10647 # perform an IMAP check
10648 option tcp-check
10649 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10650
10651 # look for the redis master server
10652 option tcp-check
10653 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010654 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010655 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10656 tcp-check expect string role:master
10657 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10658 tcp-check expect string +OK
10659
10660
10661 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10662 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10663
10664
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010665tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10666tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10667 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10668 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010670 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010671
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010672 Arguments :
10673 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10674
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010675 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10676 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010677
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010678 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10679 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010680
10681 Examples :
10682 # look for the redis master server
10683 option tcp-check
10684 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10685 tcp-check expect string role:master
10686
10687 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10688 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10689
10690
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010691tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10692tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10693 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10694 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010695 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010696 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010697
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010698 Arguments :
10699 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010700
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010701 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10702 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010703
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010704 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10705 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10706 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010707
10708 Examples :
10709 # redis check in binary
10710 option tcp-check
10711 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10712 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10713
10714
10715 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10716 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10717
10718
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010719tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010720 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010722 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010723
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010724 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010725 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10726 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10727 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10728 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10729 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10730 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10731 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10732 and '-'.
10733
10734 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10735
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010736 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010737 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10738
10739
10740tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010741 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010743 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010744
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010745 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010746 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10747 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10748 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10749 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10750 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10751 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10752 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10753 and '-'.
10754
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010755 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010756 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10757
10758
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010759tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10760 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10762 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010763 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010764 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10765 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010766
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010767 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010768
10769 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10770 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010771 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10772 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10773 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10774 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10775 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10776 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010777
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010778 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10779 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10780 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10781 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010782
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010783 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010784 - accept :
10785 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10786 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10787 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010788
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010789 - reject :
10790 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10791 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10792 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10793 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10794 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10795 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10796 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10797 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10798 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10799 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10800 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010801 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010802
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010803 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10804 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10805 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10806 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10807 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10808 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10809 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10810 hosts.
10811
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010812 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10813 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10814 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10815 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10816 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10817 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10818 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10819 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10820
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010821 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10822 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10823 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10824 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10825 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10826 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10827 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10828 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10829 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010830 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10831 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010832
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010833 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010834 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010835 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10836 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10837 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010838 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010839 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10840 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10841 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10842 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10843 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10844 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10845 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10846 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010847
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010848 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010849 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010850 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010851 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010852 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10853 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10854 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010855
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010856 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10857 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10858 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10859 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010860
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010861 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10862 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10863 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10864 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10865 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010866 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10867 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10868 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10869 layer7 information is extracted.
10870
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010871 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10872 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10873 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10874 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10875 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010876
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010877 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10878 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10879 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10880 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10881
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010882 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10883 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10884 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10885 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10886
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010887 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10888 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10889 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10890 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10891 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010892
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010893 - set-src <expr> :
10894 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10895 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10896 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010897 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010899 Arguments:
10900 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10901 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010902
10903 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010904 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10905
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010906 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10907 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010908
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010909 - set-src-port <expr> :
10910 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10911 expression.
10912
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010913 Arguments:
10914 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10915 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010916
10917 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010918 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10919
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010920 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10921 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10922 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010923
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010924 - set-dst <expr> :
10925 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10926 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10927 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10928 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10929 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10930
10931 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10932 followed by some converters.
10933
10934 Example:
10935
10936 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10937 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10938
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010939 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10940 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10941
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010942 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10943 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10944 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10945 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10946
10947
10948 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10949 followed by some converters.
10950
10951 Example:
10952
10953 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10954
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010955 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10956 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10957 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10958
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010959 - "silent-drop" :
10960 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010961 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010962 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10963 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10964 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10965 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10966 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010967 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10968 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010969 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10970 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010971 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010972 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10973 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10974 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10975 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010977 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10978 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10979 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010980
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010981 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10982 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10983 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010984
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010985 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010986 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010987 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010989 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10990 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10991 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010993 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010994 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10995 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010996
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010997 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10998
10999 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11000
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011001 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11002
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011003 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011004
11005
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011006tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11007 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011009 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011010 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011011 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11012 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011013
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011014 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011015
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011016 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011017 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11018 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11019 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11020 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011022 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11023 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11024 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11025 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011026 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11027 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11028 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11029 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11030 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11031 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011032 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011033 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011035 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11036 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11037 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11038 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011039
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011040 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011041 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011042 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011043 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11044 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011045 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011046 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011047 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011048 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011049 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011050 - set-dst <expr>
11051 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011052 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011053 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011054 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011055 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011056 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011058 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11059 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011060 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11061 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011062
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011063 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11064 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11065 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11066 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11067 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11068 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011069
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011070 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011071 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11072 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011073
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011074 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011075 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11076 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11077 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11078 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011079 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11080 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11081 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011082
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011083 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011084 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11085 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11086 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011087
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011088 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11089 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11090
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011091 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011092 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11093 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011094
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011095 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11096 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011097 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011098 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11099 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011100 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011101 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011102 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011103 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11104 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011105 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011106 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11107 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011108
11109 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11110 followed by some converters.
11111
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011112 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11113 <var-name>.
11114
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011115 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11116 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11117 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11118 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11119 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11120
11121 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11122 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11123 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11124 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11125 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11126 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11127 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11128 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11129 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11130 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11131 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11132
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011133 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11134 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11135 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11136 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11137 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11138
11139 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11140
11141 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11142
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011143 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11144 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11145 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11146 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11147 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11148 evaluated.
11149
11150 Example:
11151 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11152
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011153 Example:
11154
11155 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011156 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011157
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011158 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011159 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11160 # and reject everything else.
11161 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11162 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011163 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011164 tcp-request content reject
11165
11166 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011167 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11168 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11169 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011170 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011171
11172 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11173 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11174 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011175 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011176 tcp-request content reject
11177
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011178 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011179 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011180 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011181 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011182 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11183 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011184
11185 Example:
11186 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11187 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011188 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011189
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011190 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011191 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011192
11193 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011194 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011195 # protecting all our sites
11196 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011197 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11198 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011199 ...
11200 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11201
11202 backend http_dynamic
11203 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011204 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011205 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011206 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011207 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011208 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011209 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011211 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011212
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011213 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11214 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011215
11216
11217tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11218 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011220 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011221 Arguments :
11222 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11223 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11224 as explained at the top of this document.
11225
11226 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11227 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11228 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11229 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11230 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11231
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011232 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11233 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11234 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11235 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11236
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011237 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11238 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011239 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011240 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011241 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11242 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11243 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11244 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011245
11246 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11247 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11248 it pass through unaffected.
11249
11250 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11251 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11252 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011253 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011254 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11255 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011256 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11257 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11258 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011259
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011260 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011261 "timeout client".
11262
11263
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011264tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11265 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11267 no | no | yes | yes
11268 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011269 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11270 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011271
11272 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11273
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011274 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011275 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11276 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011277 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11278 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011279
11280 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11281
11282 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11283 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11284 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11285 inserted.
11286
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011287 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011288 - accept :
11289 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11290 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11291 the rules evaluation.
11292
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011293 - close :
11294 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11295 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11296 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11297 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11298 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11299 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011300 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011301 protocols.
11302
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011303 - reject :
11304 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11305 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011306 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011307
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011308 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11309 Sets a variable.
11310
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011311 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11312 Unsets a variable.
11313
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011314 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11315 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11316 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11317 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11318
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011319 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11320 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11321 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11322 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11323
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011324 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11325 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11326 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11327 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11328 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011329
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011330 - "silent-drop" :
11331 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011332 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011333 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11334 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11335 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11336 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11337 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011338 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11339 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011340 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11341 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011342 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011343 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11344 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11345 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11346 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11347
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011348 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11349 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11350
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011351 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11352 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11353 for changing the default action to a reject.
11354
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011355 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11356 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11357 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11358 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011359 period.
11360
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011361 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11362 declared inline.
11363
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011364 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11365 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011366 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011369 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011371 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011372 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11373 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011375 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11376 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011377
11378 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11379 followed by some converters.
11380
11381 Example:
11382
11383 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11384
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011385 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11386 <var-name>.
11387
11388 Example:
11389
11390 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11391
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011392 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11393 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11394 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11395 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11396 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11397
11398 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11399
11400 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11401
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011402 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11403
11404 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11405
11406
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011407tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11408 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11410 no | yes | yes | no
11411 Arguments :
11412 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11413 below.
11414
11415 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11416
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011417 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011418 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11419 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11420 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11421 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11422 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11423 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11424 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011425 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011426 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11427 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11428 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11429 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11430 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11431 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11432 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11433 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11434 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11435 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11436 instead.
11437
11438 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11439 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11440 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11441 rules which may be inserted.
11442
11443 Several types of actions are supported :
11444 - accept : the request is accepted
11445 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11446 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11447 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011448 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011449 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011450 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011451 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011452 - silent-drop
11453
11454 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11455 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11456 sections for a complete description.
11457
11458 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11459 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11460 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11461
11462 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11463 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11464 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11465 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11466 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11467
11468 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11469 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11470
11471 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11472 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11473 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11474
11475 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11476 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11477 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11478
11479 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11480 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11481 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11482
11483 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11484 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11485 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11486
11487 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11488
11489 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11490
11491
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011492tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11493 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11495 no | no | yes | yes
11496 Arguments :
11497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11499 as explained at the top of this document.
11500
11501 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11502
11503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011504timeout check <timeout>
11505 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11506 established.
11507
11508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11509 yes | no | yes | yes
11510 Arguments:
11511 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11512 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11513 as explained at the top of this document.
11514
11515 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11516 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011517 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011518 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011519 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11520 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11521 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011522
11523 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11524 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11525
11526 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11527 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011528 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011529
11530 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11531 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11532 forget about it.
11533
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011534 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11535 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011536
11537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011538timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011539 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11541 yes | yes | yes | no
11542 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011543 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011544 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11545 as explained at the top of this document.
11546
11547 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11548 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11549 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011550 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11551 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11552 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11553 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011554 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11555 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11556 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011557 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011558 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011559 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11560 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011561 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11562 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011563
11564 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11565 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11566 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11567 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011568 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011569 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11570
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011571 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011572
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011573 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011574
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011575
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011576timeout client-fin <timeout>
11577 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11579 yes | yes | yes | no
11580 Arguments :
11581 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11582 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11583 as explained at the top of this document.
11584
11585 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11586 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11587 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11588 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11589 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11590 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11591 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011592 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11593 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11594 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011595
11596 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11597 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11598 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11599
11600 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11601
11602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011603timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011604 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11606 yes | no | yes | yes
11607 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011608 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011609 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11610 as explained at the top of this document.
11611
11612 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011613 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011614 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011615 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011616 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11617 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011618
11619 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11620 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11621 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11622 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011623 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011624 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11625
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011626 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011628
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011629timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11630 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11632 yes | yes | yes | yes
11633 Arguments :
11634 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11635 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11636 as explained at the top of this document.
11637
11638 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11639 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11640 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11641 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11642 once the request has started to present itself.
11643
11644 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11645 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11646 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11647 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11648 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11649
11650 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11651 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11652 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11653 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11654
11655 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11656 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011657 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011658 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11659 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011660 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011661
11662 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11663 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11664 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11665 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11666
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011667 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11668 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011669 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11670
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011671 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11672
11673
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011674timeout http-request <timeout>
11675 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011677 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011678 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011679 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011680 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11681 as explained at the top of this document.
11682
11683 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11684 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11685 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11686 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11687 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11688 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11689 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011690 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11691 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11692 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11693 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011694 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011695 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11696 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011697
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011698 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11699 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11700 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11701 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11702 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011703 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011704
11705 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11706 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011707 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011708 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11709 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11710
11711 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011712 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11713 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11714 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011715
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011716 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011717 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011718
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011719
11720timeout queue <timeout>
11721 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11723 yes | no | yes | yes
11724 Arguments :
11725 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11727 as explained at the top of this document.
11728
11729 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11730 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11731 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11732 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11733 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11734
11735 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11736 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11737 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11738 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11739
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011740 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011741
11742
11743timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011744 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11746 yes | no | yes | yes
11747 Arguments :
11748 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11750 as explained at the top of this document.
11751
11752 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11753 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11754 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11755 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11756 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11757 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11758 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11759
11760 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11761 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11762 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11763 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11764 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011765 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011766 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011767 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11768 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011769 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11770 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011771
11772 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11773 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11774 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11775 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011776 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011777 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11778
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011779 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011780
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011781
11782timeout server-fin <timeout>
11783 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11785 yes | no | yes | yes
11786 Arguments :
11787 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11788 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11789 as explained at the top of this document.
11790
11791 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11792 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11793 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11794 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11795 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11796 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11797 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11798 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11799 situations, it should not be needed.
11800
11801 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11802 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11803 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11804
11805 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11806
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011807
11808timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011809 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11811 yes | yes | yes | yes
11812 Arguments :
11813 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11814 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11815 as explained at the top of this document.
11816
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011817 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11818 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11819 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011820
11821 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11822 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11823 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11824 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011825 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011826
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011827 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011828
11829
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011830timeout tunnel <timeout>
11831 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11833 yes | no | yes | yes
11834 Arguments :
11835 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11836 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11837 as explained at the top of this document.
11838
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011839 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011840 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11841 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11842 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011843 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11844 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011845 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11846 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11847 specified.
11848
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011849 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11850 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11851 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11852 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11853 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11854 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11855 state.
11856
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011857 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11858 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11859 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11860 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011861 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011862
11863 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11864 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11865 forget about it.
11866
11867 Example :
11868 defaults http
11869 option http-server-close
11870 timeout connect 5s
11871 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011872 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011873 timeout server 30s
11874 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11875
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011876 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011877
11878
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011879transparent (deprecated)
11880 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011882 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011883 Arguments : none
11884
11885 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11886 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11887 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11888 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11889 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11890 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11891 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11892 appropriate server.
11893
11894 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11895
11896 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11897 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11898
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011899 See also: "option transparent"
11900
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011901unique-id-format <string>
11902 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11904 yes | yes | yes | no
11905 Arguments :
11906 <string> is a log-format string.
11907
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011908 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11909 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11910 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11911 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011912
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011913 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11914 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11915 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11916 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11917 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11918 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11919 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11920 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011921
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011922 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11923 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011924
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011925 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011926
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011927 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011928
11929 will generate:
11930
11931 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11932
11933 See also: "unique-id-header"
11934
11935unique-id-header <name>
11936 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11938 yes | yes | yes | no
11939 Arguments :
11940 <name> is the name of the header.
11941
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011942 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11943 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011944
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011945 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011946
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011947 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011948 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11949
11950 will generate:
11951
11952 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11953
11954 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011955
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011956use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011957 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11959 no | yes | yes | no
11960 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011961 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11962 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011963
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011964 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11965 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011966
11967 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11968 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11969 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011970 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011971 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011972 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11973 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011974
11975 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11976 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11977 assign the backend.
11978
11979 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11980 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11981 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11982 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11983 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11984 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11985
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011986 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011987 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011988 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11989 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11990 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11991
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011992 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11993 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11994 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11995 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11996 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11997 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11998 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11999 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12000 cannot be forced from the request.
12001
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012002 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012003 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12004 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12005
12006 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12007 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012008
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012009use-fcgi-app <name>
12010 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12012 no | no | yes | yes
12013 Arguments :
12014 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12015
12016 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012017
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012018use-server <server> if <condition>
12019use-server <server> unless <condition>
12020 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12022 no | no | yes | yes
12023 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012024 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12025 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012026
12027 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12028
12029 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12030 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12031 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12032
12033 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12034 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12035 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12036 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12037 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12038 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12039 matches will assign the server.
12040
12041 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12042 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12043 with the next rules until one matches.
12044
12045 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12046 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12047 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12048 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12049
12050 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12051 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12052 stripped.
12053
12054 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12055 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
12056 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
12057 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
12058
12059 Example :
12060 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12061 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12062 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12063 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
12064 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
12065 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012066 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012067 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12068 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12069
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012070 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12071 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12072 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12073 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012074 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012075 and we fall back to load balancing.
12076
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012077 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012078
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012079
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120805. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012081--------------------------
12082
12083The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12084depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12085settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12086written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12087described in this section.
12088
12089
120905.1. Bind options
12091-----------------
12092
12093The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12094as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12095no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12096parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12097while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12098provided immediately after the setting name.
12099
12100The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12101
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012102accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12103 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12104 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12105 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12106 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12107 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12108 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12109 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12110 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12111 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012112 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12113 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12114 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012115
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012116accept-proxy
12117 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012118 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12119 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012120 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12121 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12122 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12123 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012124 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012125 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12126 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012127 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12128 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012129
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012130allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012131 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012132 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012133 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012134 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12135 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012136
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012137alpn <protocols>
12138 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12139 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12140 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012141 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012142 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012143 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12144 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12145 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12146 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12147 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12148 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12149 preference, like below :
12150
12151 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012152
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012153backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012154 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012155 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12156
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012157curves <curves>
12158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12159 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12160 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12161 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12162 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12163 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12164
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012165ecdhe <named curve>
12166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012167 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12168 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012169
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012170ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12172 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12173 client's certificate.
12174
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012175ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12176 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12177 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12178 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12179 error is ignored.
12180
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012181ca-sign-file <cafile>
12182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12183 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12184 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12185 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12186 'generate-certificates' for details.
12187
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012188ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12190 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12191 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12192 'generate-certificates' for details.
12193
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012194ca-verify-file <cafile>
12195 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12196 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12197 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12198 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12199 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12200
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012201ciphers <ciphers>
12202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12203 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012204 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012205 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012206 information and recommendations see e.g.
12207 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12208 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12209 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12210
12211ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12212 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12213 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12214 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12215 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012216 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12217 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012218
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012219crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12221 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12222 to verify client's certificate.
12223
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012224crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012225 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12226 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12227 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12228 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12229 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012230 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12231 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012232
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012233 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12234 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12235
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012236 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12237 are loaded.
12238
12239 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012240 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12241 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12242 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12243 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12244 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12245 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12246 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012247 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012248
12249 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12250 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12251 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12252 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012253 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12254 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012255
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012256 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012257
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012258 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012259 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012260 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12261 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012262 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12263 clients).
12264
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012265 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12266 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12267 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12268 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12269 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12270 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12271 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12272 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12273 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12274 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12275 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12276 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12277 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12278
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012279 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12280 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12281 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12282 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12283 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12284
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012285 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12286 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12287 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12288 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012289
12290 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12291 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12292 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12293 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12294 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12295 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12296 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12297 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12298 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12299
12300 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12301
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012302 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012303 a cert bundle.
12304
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012305 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012306 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12307 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12308 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12309 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12310 provide multi-cert support.
12311
12312 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12313
12314 Filename | CN | SAN
12315 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12316 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012317 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012318 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12319 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12320
12321 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12322 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12323 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12324 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012325 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12326 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12327 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012328
12329 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12330 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12331
12332 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12333 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12334 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12335
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012336crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012337 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012338 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012339 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012340 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012341
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012342crt-list <file>
12343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012344 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12345 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012346
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012347 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12348
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012349 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12350 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12351 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12352 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12353 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012354
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012355 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12356 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12357 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12358 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12359 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12360 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12361 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12362 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012363
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012364 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012365 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012366 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12367 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12368 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012369
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012370 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12371
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012372 crt-list file example:
12373 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012374 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012375 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012376 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012377 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012378
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012379defer-accept
12380 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12381 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12382 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012383 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012384 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12385 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12386 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12387 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12388 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12389 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12390 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12391
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012392expose-fd listeners
12393 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12394 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012395 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12396 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012397 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012398
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012399force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012400 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012401 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012402 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012403 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012404
12405force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012406 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012407 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012408 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012409
12410force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012411 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012412 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012413 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012414
12415force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012416 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012417 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012418 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012419
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012420force-tlsv13
12421 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12422 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012423 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012424
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012425generate-certificates
12426 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12427 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12428 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12429 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12430 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12431 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12432 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12433 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12434 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12435 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12436 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12437
12438 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12439 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012440 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012441 certificate is used many times.
12442
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012443gid <gid>
12444 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12445 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12446 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12447 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12448 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12449
12450group <group>
12451 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12452 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12453 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12454 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12455 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12456
12457id <id>
12458 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12459 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12460 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12461 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12462
12463interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012464 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12465 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12466 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12467 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12468 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12469 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012470 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12471 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12472 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12473 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12474 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12475 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012476
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012477level <level>
12478 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12479 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12480 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012481 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012482 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12483 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12484 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012485 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012486 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012487 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012488 all counters).
12489
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012490severity-output <format>
12491 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12492 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12493 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12494 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12495 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12496 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12497 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12498 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12499 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12500 rfc5424 convention.
12501
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012502maxconn <maxconn>
12503 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12504 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12505 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12506 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12507 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12508 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12509 eat all memory.
12510
12511mode <mode>
12512 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12513 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12514 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12515 UNIX sockets.
12516
12517mss <maxseg>
12518 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12519 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12520 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12521 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12522 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12523 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12524 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12525 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12526 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12527 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12528 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12529
12530name <name>
12531 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12532 page.
12533
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012534namespace <name>
12535 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12536 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12537 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12538 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12539
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012540nice <nice>
12541 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12542 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12543 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12544 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12545 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12546 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12547 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12548 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12549 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12550 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12551 one for an RDP socket.
12552
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012553no-ca-names
12554 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12555 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012556 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012557
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012558no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012559 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012560 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012561 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012562 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012563 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12564 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012565
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012566no-tls-tickets
12567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12568 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12569 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012570 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12571 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012572 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12573 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12574 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012575
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012576no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012578 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012579 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012580 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012581 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12582 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012583
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012584no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012586 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012587 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012588 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012589 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12590 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012591
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012592no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012593 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012594 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012595 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012596 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012597 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12598 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012599
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012600no-tlsv13
12601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12602 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12603 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12604 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012605 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12606 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012607
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012608npn <protocols>
12609 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12610 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12611 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012612 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012613 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012614 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12615 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12616 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12617 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12618 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012619
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012620prefer-client-ciphers
12621 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12622 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12623 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012624 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12625 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12626 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012627
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012628process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012629 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012630 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012631 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012632 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12633 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12634 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12635 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012636 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012637 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12638 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12639 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12640 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12641 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012642
12643 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12644
12645 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12646 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12647 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12648 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12649 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12650 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12651 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12652 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012653
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012654proto <name>
12655 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12656 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12657 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12658 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012659 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012660 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012661 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012662 h2" on the bind line.
12663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012664ssl
12665 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012666 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012667 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12668 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012669 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12670 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012671
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012672ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12673 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012674 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12675 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12676 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012677 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12678
12679ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012680 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12681 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12682 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12683 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012684
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012685strict-sni
12686 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12687 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12688 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12689 See the "crt" option for more information.
12690
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012691tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012692 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012693 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12694 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012695 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012696 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12697 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12698 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12699 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12700 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12701 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12702 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12703
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012704tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012705 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012706 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12707 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12708 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12709 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12710 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12711 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12712 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012713 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12714 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12715 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012716
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012717tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12718 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012719 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12720 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12721 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12722 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12723 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12724 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12725 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12726 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12727 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12728 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012729 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12730 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12731
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012732transparent
12733 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12734 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12735 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12736 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12737 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12738 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12739 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12740 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12741 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12742 so check for support with your vendor.
12743
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012744v4v6
12745 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12746 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12747 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12748 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012749 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012750
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012751v6only
12752 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12753 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12754 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012755 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12756 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012757
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012758uid <uid>
12759 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12760 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12761 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12762 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12763 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12764
12765user <user>
12766 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12767 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12768 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12769 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12770 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12771
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012772verify [none|optional|required]
12773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12774 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12775 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12776 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12777 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012778 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12779 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12780 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12781 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200127835.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012784------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012786The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12787which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12788arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12789settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12790after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12791Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12792address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012794 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012795 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012796
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012797Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12798keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012800The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012801
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012802addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012803 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012804 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12805 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12806 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12807 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12808 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012809
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012810agent-check
12811 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012812 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012813 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12814 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12815 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012816
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012817 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012818 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012819 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12820 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12821 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012822
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012823 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12824 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12825 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12826 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12827 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012828
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012829 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012830 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012831
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012832 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12833 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12834 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012835
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012836 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12837 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12838 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012839
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012840 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12841 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12842 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12843 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12844 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012845 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012846 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012847
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012848 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12849 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012850
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012851 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12852 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12853 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12854 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12855 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12856 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12857 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12858 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12859 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012860
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012861 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12862 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012863 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12864 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12865 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012866 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012867
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012868 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012869 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012870
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012871agent-send <string>
12872 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12873 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12874 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12875 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12876 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12877
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012878agent-inter <delay>
12879 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12880 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12881
12882 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12883 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12884 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12885 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12886 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12887 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12888 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12889 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12890 of backends use the same servers.
12891
12892 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12893
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012894agent-addr <addr>
12895 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12896
12897 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12898 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12899 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12900 hostname, it will be resolved.
12901
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012902agent-port <port>
12903 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12904
12905 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12906
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012907allow-0rtt
12908 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012909 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12910 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012911
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012912alpn <protocols>
12913 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12914 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12915 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012916 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012917 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12918 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12919 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12920 now obsolete NPN extension.
12921 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12922 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12923
12924 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012926backup
12927 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12928 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12929 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12930 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012931 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12932 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012933
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012934ca-file <cafile>
12935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12936 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12937 server's certificate.
12938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012939check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012940 This option enables health checks on a server:
12941 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12942 considered available.
12943 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12944 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12945 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12946 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12947 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12948 set.
12949 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12950 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12951 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12952 exchanges succeed.
12953
12954 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12955 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12956 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12957 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12958 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012959 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012960 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12961
12962 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12963 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12964
12965 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12966 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12967
12968 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12969 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12970 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12971 available.
12972
12973 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12974 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12975 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12976
12977 Example:
12978 # simple tcp check
12979 backend foo
12980 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12981 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12982 backend foo
12983 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12984 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12985 backend foo
12986 option tcp-check
12987 tcp-check connect
12988 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012989
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012990check-send-proxy
12991 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12992 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12993 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12994 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12995 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12996 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12997 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12998
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012999check-alpn <protocols>
13000 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13001 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13002 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13003
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013004check-proto <name>
13005 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13006 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13007 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13008 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013009 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013010 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13011 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13012
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013013check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013014 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013015 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13016 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013017
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013018check-ssl
13019 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13020 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13021 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13022 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013023 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013024 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13025 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013026 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013027 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13028 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013029
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013030check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013031 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013032 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13033 for normal traffic.
13034
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013035ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13037 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13038 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013039 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13040 information and recommendations see e.g.
13041 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13042 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13043 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013044
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013045ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13047 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13048 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13049 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013050 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13051 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13052 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013054cookie <value>
13055 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13056 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13057 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13058 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13059 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13060 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13061 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13062
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013063crl-file <crlfile>
13064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13065 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13066 to verify server's certificate.
13067
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013068crt <cert>
13069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13070 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13071 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13072 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13073 certificate request.
13074
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013075disabled
13076 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13077 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13078 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13079 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13080 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013081 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013082
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013083enabled
13084 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13085 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13086 default value.
13087 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13088 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013090error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013091 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13092 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13093 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013095 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013097fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013098 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13099 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13100 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13101
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013102force-sslv3
13103 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13104 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013105 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013106 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013107
13108force-tlsv10
13109 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013110 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013111 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013112
13113force-tlsv11
13114 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013115 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013116 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013117
13118force-tlsv12
13119 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013120 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013121 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013122
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013123force-tlsv13
13124 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13125 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013126 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013128id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013129 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13130 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13131 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013132
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013133init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13134 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13135 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013136 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013137 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13138 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13139 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13140 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13141 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13142 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13143 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13144 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13145 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013146 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013147 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13148 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13149 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13150 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13151 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13152 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013153 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013154
13155 Example:
13156 defaults
13157 # never fail on address resolution
13158 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013160inter <delay>
13161fastinter <delay>
13162downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013163 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13164 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13165 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13166 between checks depending on the server state :
13167
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013168 Server state | Interval used
13169 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13170 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13171 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13172 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13173 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13174 or yet unchecked. |
13175 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13176 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13177 | "inter" otherwise.
13178 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013180 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13181 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13182 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13183 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013184 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13185 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13186 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13187 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13188 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013189
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013190log-proto <logproto>
13191 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13192 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13193 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13194 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013196maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013197 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13198 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013199 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13200 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013201 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13202 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13203 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13204 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13205
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013206 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13207 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13208 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13209 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13210 than 50 concurrent requests.
13211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013212maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013213 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13214 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13215 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13216 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13217 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13218 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13219 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13220
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013221max-reuse <count>
13222 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13223 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13224 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13225 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13226 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13227 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13228 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13229 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013231minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013232 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13233 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13234 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13235 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13236 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13237 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013238 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013239 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013240
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013241namespace <name>
13242 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13243 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13244 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13245 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13246
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013247no-agent-check
13248 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13249 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13250 default value.
13251 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13252 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13253
13254no-backup
13255 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13256 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13257 default value.
13258 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13259 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13260
13261no-check
13262 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13263 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13264 default value.
13265 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13266 "default-server" "check" setting.
13267
13268no-check-ssl
13269 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13270 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13271 default value.
13272 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13273 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13274
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013275no-send-proxy
13276 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13277 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13278 default value.
13279 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13280 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13281
13282no-send-proxy-v2
13283 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13284 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13285 default value.
13286 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13287 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13288
13289no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13290 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13291 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13292 default value.
13293 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13294 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13295
13296no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13297 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13298 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13299 default value.
13300 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13301 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13302
13303no-ssl
13304 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13305 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13306 default value.
13307 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13308 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13309
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013310no-ssl-reuse
13311 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13312 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13313 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13314 and for paranoid users.
13315
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013316no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013317 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13318 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013319 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013320
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013321 Supported in default-server: No
13322
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013323no-tls-tickets
13324 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13325 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13326 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013327 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13328 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013329 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13330 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13331 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013332 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013333
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013334no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013335 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013336 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13337 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013338 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13339 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013340 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013341
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013342 Supported in default-server: No
13343
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013344no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013345 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013346 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13347 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013348 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13349 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013350 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013351
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013352 Supported in default-server: No
13353
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013354no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013355 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013356 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13357 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013358 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13359 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013360 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013361
13362 Supported in default-server: No
13363
13364no-tlsv13
13365 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13366 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13367 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13368 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13369 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013370 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013371
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013372 Supported in default-server: No
13373
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013374no-verifyhost
13375 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13376 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13377 default value.
13378 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13379 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013380
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013381no-tfo
13382 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13383 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13384 default value.
13385 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13386 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13387
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013388non-stick
13389 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13390 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13391 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13392
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013393npn <protocols>
13394 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13395 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13396 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013397 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013398 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13399 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13400 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013402observe <mode>
13403 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13404 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13405 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13406 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13407 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13408 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013409 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013410
13411 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013413on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013414 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13415 Currently, four modes are available:
13416 - fastinter: force fastinter
13417 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13418 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13419 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13420 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13421
13422 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13423
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013424on-marked-down <action>
13425 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13426 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013427 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13428 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13429 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13430 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13431 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13432 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13433 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13434 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013435
13436 Actions are disabled by default
13437
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013438on-marked-up <action>
13439 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13440 Currently one action is available:
13441 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13442 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13443 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13444 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013445 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13446 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013447 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13448 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13449
13450 Actions are disabled by default
13451
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013452pool-low-conn <max>
13453 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13454 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13455 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13456 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13457 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13458 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13459 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13460 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13461 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13462 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13463 applying to "http-reuse".
13464
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013465pool-max-conn <max>
13466 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13467 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13468 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13469 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13470 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13471 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13472
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013473pool-purge-delay <delay>
13474 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013475 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013476 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013478port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013479 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13480 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13481 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13482 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13483 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13484 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13485
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013486proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013487 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13488 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13489 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13490 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013491 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013492 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013494redir <prefix>
13495 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13496 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13497 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13498 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13499 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13500 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13501 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13502 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013503 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013504 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013505 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13506 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13507 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13508 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13509
13510 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013512rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013513 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13514 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13515 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13516
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013517resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13518 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13519 server.
13520
13521 Available options:
13522
13523 * allow-dup-ip
13524 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13525 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13526 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13527 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13528 For such case, simply enable this option.
13529 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13530
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013531 * ignore-weight
13532 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13533 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13534 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13535
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013536 * prevent-dup-ip
13537 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13538 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13539 same fqdn.
13540 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13541
13542 Example:
13543 backend b_myapp
13544 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13545 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13546 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13547
13548 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13549 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13550 it
13551 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13552 different address
13553
13554 Default value: not set
13555
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013556resolve-prefer <family>
13557 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13558 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13559 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13560 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13561
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013562 Default value: ipv6
13563
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013564 Example:
13565
13566 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013567
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013568resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013569 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013570 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013571 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013572 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13573 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013574 configured network, another address is selected.
13575
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013576 Example:
13577
13578 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013579
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013580resolvers <id>
13581 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13582 hostname.
13583
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013584 Example:
13585
13586 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013587
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013588 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013589
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013590send-proxy
13591 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13592 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13593 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13594 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013595 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13596 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13597 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13598 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13599 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13600 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13601 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13602 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13603 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13604 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013605 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13606 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013607
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013608send-proxy-v2
13609 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13610 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13611 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13612 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013613 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13614 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13615 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13616 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013617
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013618proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013619 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13620 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13621
13622 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13623 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13624 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13625 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13626 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13627 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13628 connection is supported).
13629 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13630 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13631 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13632 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13633 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13634 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13635 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013636
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013637send-proxy-v2-ssl
13638 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13639 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13640 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13641 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13642 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13643 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13644 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013645 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13646 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013647
13648send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13649 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13650 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13651 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13652 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13653 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13654 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13655 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13656 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013657 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13658 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013660slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013661 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13662 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13663 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13664 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13665 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13666 parameters :
13667
13668 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13669 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13670
13671 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13672 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13673 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13674 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13675
13676 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13677 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13678 seen as failed.
13679
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013680sni <expression>
13681 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13682 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13683 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13684 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013685 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13686 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013687 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013688 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13689 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013690
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013691source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013692source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013693source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013694 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13695 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13696 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13697 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13698
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013699 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13700 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13701 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13702 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13703 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13704 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13705 server.
13706
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013707 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13708 specifying the source address without port(s).
13709
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013710ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013711 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13712 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13713 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13714 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13715 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13716 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013717 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13718 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013719
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013720ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13721 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13722 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13723 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13724
13725ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13726 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13727 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13728 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13729
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013730ssl-reuse
13731 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13732 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13733 default value.
13734 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13735 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13736
13737stick
13738 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13739 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13740 default value.
13741 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13742 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013743
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013744socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013745 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013746 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13747 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13748
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013749tcp-ut <delay>
13750 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13751 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13752 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013753 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013754 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13755 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13756 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13757 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13758 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13759 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13760 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13761 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13762 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13763
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013764tfo
13765 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13766 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13767 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13768 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13769 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013770 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013772track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013773 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13774 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13775 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13776 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013777 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13778
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013779tls-tickets
13780 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13781 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13782 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013783 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13784 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13785 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013786 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013787 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013788
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013789verify [none|required]
13790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013791 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013792 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13793 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013794 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013795 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13796 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13797 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13798 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13799 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13800 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13801 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13802 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013803
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013804verifyhost <hostname>
13805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013806 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13807 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13808 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13809 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13810 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13811 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13812 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13813 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013815weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013816 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13817 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13818 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013819 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13820 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13821 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13822 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13823 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13824 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013825
13826
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138275.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13828-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013829
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013830HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13831using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13832configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013833This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13834can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13835workload.
13836This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13837resolution at run time.
13838Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13839carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13840
13841
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138425.3.1. Global overview
13843----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013844
13845As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13846different steps of the process life:
13847
13848 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13849 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13850 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13851
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013852 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13853 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013854
13855A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13856 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13857 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13858 resolution to know this new IP.
13859
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013860When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013861HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013862SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13863from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13864will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13865will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013866
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013867A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013868 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013869 first valid response.
13870
13871 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13872 servers return an error.
13873
13874
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138755.3.2. The resolvers section
13876----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013877
13878This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013879HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13880contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013881
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013882When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13883uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13884is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13885answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13886
13887When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013888used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013889
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013890 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13891 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13892 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013893
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013894 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13895 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013896
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013897 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13898 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13899 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013900
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013901For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13902following scenarios are possible:
13903
13904 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13905 ignored
13906
13907 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13908 applied
13909
13910 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13911 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13912
13913 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13914 retries the query with a new type
13915
13916 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13917 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013918
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013919As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13920a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013921<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013922
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013923
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013924resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013925 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013926
13927A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13928
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013929accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013930 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013931 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013932 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13933 by RFC 6891)
13934
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013935 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13936
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013937nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13938 DNS server description:
13939 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13940 <ip> : IP address of the server
13941 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13942
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013943parse-resolv-conf
13944 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13945 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13946 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13947
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013948hold <status> <period>
13949 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13950 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013951 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013952 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013953 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13954 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13955 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13956
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013957 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013958
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013959resolve_retries <nb>
13960 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13961 giving up.
13962 Default value: 3
13963
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013964 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13965 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13966 type.
13967
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013968timeout <event> <time>
13969 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13970 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13971 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013972 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13973 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013974 Default value: 1s
13975 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013976 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013977 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013978 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13979 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13980
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013981 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013982
13983 resolvers mydns
13984 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13985 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013986 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013987 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013988 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013989 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013990 hold other 30s
13991 hold refused 30s
13992 hold nx 30s
13993 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013994 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013995 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013996
13997
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200139986. Cache
13999---------
14000
14001HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14002(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14003RAM.
14004
14005The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14006this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14007
14008If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14009independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14010when we try to allocate a new one.
14011
14012The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14013
14014It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14015"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14016for more details.
14017
14018When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14019replaced by "<CACHE>".
14020
14021
140226.1. Limitation
14023----------------
14024
14025The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14026
14027- If the response is not a 200
14028- If the response contains a Vary header
14029- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14030- If the response is not cacheable
14031
14032- If the request is not a GET
14033- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14034- If the request contains an Authorization header
14035
14036
140376.2. Setup
14038-----------
14039
14040To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14041the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14042
14043
140446.2.1. Cache section
14045---------------------
14046
14047cache <name>
14048 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14049 size of cache is mandatory.
14050
14051total-max-size <megabytes>
14052 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14053 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14054
14055max-object-size <bytes>
14056 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14057 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14058 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14059
14060max-age <seconds>
14061 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14062 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14063 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14064 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14065 default.
14066
14067
140686.2.2. Proxy section
14069---------------------
14070
14071http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14072 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14073 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14074 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14075 after this one.
14076
14077http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14078 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14079 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14080 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14081 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14082
14083
14084Example:
14085
14086 backend bck1
14087 mode http
14088
14089 http-request cache-use foobar
14090 http-response cache-store foobar
14091 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14092
14093 cache foobar
14094 total-max-size 4
14095 max-age 240
14096
14097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140987. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14099----------------------------------
14100
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014101HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014102client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14103The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14104these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14105but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14106data called patterns.
14107
14108
141097.1. ACL basics
14110---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014111
14112The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14113content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14114from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14115simple :
14116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014117 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014118 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014119 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14120 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014122The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14123adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014124
14125In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014127 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014128
14129This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14130Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14131and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014132an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14133conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14134as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14135are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014136
14137ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14138'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14139which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14140
14141There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14142performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14145specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14146this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014147methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14148ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014149
14150Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14151 - boolean
14152 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14153 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14154 - string
14155 - data block
14156
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014157Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14158converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14159would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14160The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14161which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14162
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014163Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14164keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14165fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14166which are summarized in the table below :
14167
14168 +---------------------+-----------------+
14169 | Sample or converter | Default |
14170 | output type | matching method |
14171 +---------------------+-----------------+
14172 | boolean | bool |
14173 +---------------------+-----------------+
14174 | integer | int |
14175 +---------------------+-----------------+
14176 | ip | ip |
14177 +---------------------+-----------------+
14178 | string | str |
14179 +---------------------+-----------------+
14180 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14181 +---------------------+-----------------+
14182
14183Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14184matching method, see below.
14185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014186The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14187 - boolean
14188 - integer or integer range
14189 - IP address / network
14190 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14191 - regular expression
14192 - hex block
14193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014194The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14195
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014196 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14197 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014198 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014199 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014200 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014201 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014202 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014204The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14205read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14206if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14207lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14208will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14209beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14210a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14211lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14212exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14213
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014214The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14215parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14216ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14217a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14218check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14219
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014220The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14221socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14222file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14225loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14226
14227 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14228
14229In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14230the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14231case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14232as well.
14233
14234The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14235sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14236do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14237methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14238is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014239obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014240followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14241default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14242that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14243string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14244
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014245The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14246By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14247string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14248resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14249server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014250waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014251flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14252function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14255sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14256be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014257
14258 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14259 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014260 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14261 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14262 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14263 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014264
14265 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14266 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014267 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014268
14269 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014271
14272 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014273 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014275 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014276 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14277
14278 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14279 binary or string samples.
14280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014281 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14282 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014284 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14285 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14286 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014288 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14289 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014291 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14292 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014294 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14295 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014297 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14298 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014299 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014301 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14302 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14303 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014304
14305For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14306request, it is possible to do :
14307
14308 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14309
14310In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14311buffer, one would use the following acl :
14312
14313 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14314
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014315On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14316possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14317
14318 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14321criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14322method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14323to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14324criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14325the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014327If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014328the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14329For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14332 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14333 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14334 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014335
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014336
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014337The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14338types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14339combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14340brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14341default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014343 +-------------------------------------------------+
14344 | Input sample type |
14345 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014346 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014347 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14348 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14349 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014350 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014351 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014352 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014354 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014356 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014357 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014358 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014360 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014361 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014362 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014363 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014364 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014365 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014366 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014367 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014368 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014370 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14372 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14373 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014374
14375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143767.1.1. Matching booleans
14377------------------------
14378
14379In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14380Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14381When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14382that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14383
14384Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14385return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14386"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14387
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143897.1.2. Matching integers
14390------------------------
14391
14392Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14393enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14394to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14395
14396Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14397matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14398lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014399
14400For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14401unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14402representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14403
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014404As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14405two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14406instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14407ranges and operators.
14408
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014409For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014410operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14411Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14412of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014414Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014415
14416 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14417 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14418 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14419 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14420 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014422For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014423
14424 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14425
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014426This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14427
14428 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14429
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144317.1.3. Matching strings
14432-----------------------
14433
14434String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14435different forms :
14436
14437 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014438 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439
14440 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014441 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014442
14443 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14444 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14445
14446 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14447 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14448
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014449 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14451 matches.
14452
14453 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14454 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14455 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014456
14457String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14458exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14459characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14460string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14461to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014462before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014463
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014464Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14465(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14466Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14467
14468Example:
14469 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14470 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14471
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14474---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014475
14476Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14477they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14478possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14479passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14480the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014481the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14482match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014483
14484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144857.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14486-------------------------------------
14487
14488It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14489not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14490a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14491to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14492digits may be used upper or lower case.
14493
14494Example :
14495 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14496 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14497
14498
144997.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14500---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014501
14502IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14503netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14504within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014505host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014506difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14507at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14508does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14509parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014510
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014511The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14512abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14513
14514 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14515 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14516 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14517 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14518 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14519 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14520 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14521 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14522
14523Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14524192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14525
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014526IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14527Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14528trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14529IPv6 patterns.
14530
14531HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14532following situations :
14533 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14534 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14535 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14536 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14537 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14538 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14539 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14540 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14541 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14542 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014544
145457.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14546----------------------------------
14547
14548Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14549combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14550
14551 - AND (implicit)
14552 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14553 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014557 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014559Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14560indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14563"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14564requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14565is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14566
14567 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014568 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14569 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14570 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571
14572To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14573and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14574
14575 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14576 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14577 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14578 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14579
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014580 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014581 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14582 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14583 use_backend www if host_www
14584
14585It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14586expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14587be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14588the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14589
14590 The following rule :
14591
14592 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014593 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014594
14595 Can also be written that way :
14596
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014597 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014598
14599It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14600to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14601simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14602sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14603good use is the following :
14604
14605 With named ACLs :
14606
14607 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14608 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14609 monitor fail if site_dead
14610
14611 With anonymous ACLs :
14612
14613 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14614
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014615See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14616keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014617
14618
146197.3. Fetching samples
14620---------------------
14621
14622Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14623against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14624sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14625ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14626of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14627available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14628
14629This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14630Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14631compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14632deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14633
14634The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14635matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14636method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14637indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14638
14639As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14640when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14641mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14642the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14643ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14644
14645Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14646multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14647when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014648incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14649are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14651all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14652
14653Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14654 - name
14655 - name(arg1)
14656 - name(arg1,arg2)
14657
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014658
146597.3.1. Converters
14660-----------------
14661
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014662Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14663of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14664is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14665was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014666has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014667unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14668
14669These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14670sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14671the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014672support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014673
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014674A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14675support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14676supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14677(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14678bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014680The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014681
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001468251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14683 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14684 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14685 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14686 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14687 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14688
14689 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014690 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14691 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014692 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14693 frontend http-in
14694 bind *:8081
14695 default_backend servers
14696 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14697 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14698
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014699add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014700 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014701 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014702 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14703 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014704 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014705 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14706 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14707 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14708 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014709 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014710 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014711
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014712aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14713 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14714 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14715 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14716 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14717 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14718 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14719
14720 Example:
14721 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14722 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14723
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014724and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014725 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014726 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014727 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14728 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014729 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014730 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14731 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14732 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14733 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014734 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014735 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014736
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014737b64dec
14738 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14739 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14740
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014741base64
14742 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014743 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014744 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14745
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014746bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014747 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014748 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014749 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014750 presence of a flag).
14751
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014752bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14753 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14754 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014755 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014756
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014757concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14758 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14759 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14760 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14761 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14762 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14763 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14764 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14765 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14766 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14767 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014768 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014769 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014770 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14771 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014772
14773 Example:
14774 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14775 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14776 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014777 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014778 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14779
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014780cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014781 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14782 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014783
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014784crc32([<avalanche>])
14785 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14786 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14787 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14788 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14789 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14790 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14791 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14792 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14793 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14794 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014795 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14796
14797crc32c([<avalanche>])
14798 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14799 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14800 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14801 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14802 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14803 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14804 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14805 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014806
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014807cut_crlf
14808 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14809 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14810 updated.
14811
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014812da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014813 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14814 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14815 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14816 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014817 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014818 configuration language.
14819
14820 Example:
14821 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014822 bind *:8881
14823 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014824 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014825
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014826debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14827 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14828 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14829 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14830 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14831 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14832 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14833 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14834 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14835 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14836 printable sample types.
14837
14838 Example:
14839 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014840
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014841digest(<algorithm>)
14842 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14843 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14844
14845 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14846 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14847
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014848div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014849 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14850 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014851 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014852 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14853 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14856 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14857 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14858 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014859 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014860 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014861
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014862djb2([<avalanche>])
14863 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14864 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14865 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14866 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14867 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14868 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14869 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014870 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14871 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014872
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014873even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014874 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014875 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14876
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014877field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14878 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14879 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14880 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14881 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14882 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14883 fields.
14884
14885 Example :
14886 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14887 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14888 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14889 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14890 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014891
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014892hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014893 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014894 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014895 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014896 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014897
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014898hex2i
14899 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014900 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014901
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014902htonl
14903 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14904 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14905 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14906 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14907
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014908hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14909 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14910 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14911 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14912 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14913
14914 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14915 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14916
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014917http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014918 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14919 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014920 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14921 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14922 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14923 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14924 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14925 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14926 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14927 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014928
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014929in_table(<table>)
14930 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14931 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14932 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014933 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014934 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14935
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014936ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14937 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014938 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014939 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14940 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14941 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14942 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14943 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014944
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014945json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014946 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014947 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014948 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014949 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14950 of errors:
14951 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14952 bytes, ...)
14953 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14954 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14955
14956 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14957 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14958 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14959 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14960 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14961 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014962 - "ascii" : never fails;
14963 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14964 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014965 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014966 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014967 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14968 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14969
14970 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014971 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014972
14973 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014974 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014975 capture request header user-agent len 150
14976 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014977
14978 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14979 GET / HTTP/1.0
14980 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14981
14982 Output log:
14983 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14984
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014985language(<value>[,<default>])
14986 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14987 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14988 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14989 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14990 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14991 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14992 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14993 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14994 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014995 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014996 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14997 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014998
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014999 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015000
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015001 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15002 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015003
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015004 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15005 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15006 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15007 use_backend spanish if es
15008 use_backend french if fr
15009 use_backend english if en
15010 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015011
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015012length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015013 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15014 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15015 type. The result is of type integer.
15016
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015017lower
15018 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15019 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15020 type. The result is of type string.
15021
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015022ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15023 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15024 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15025 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15026 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15027 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15028 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15029
15030 Example :
15031
15032 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015033 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015034 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15035
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015036ltrim(<chars>)
15037 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15038 representation of the input sample.
15039
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015040map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15041map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15042map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15043 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15044 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15045 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15046 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15047 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15048 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15049 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15050 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015052 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15053 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15054 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015055
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015056 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015057 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015058
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015059 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15060 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15061 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15062 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015063 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15064 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015065 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15066 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15067 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15068 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15069 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15070 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15071 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15072 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015073 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15074 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15075 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015076 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15077 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15078 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15079 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15080 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015081
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015082 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15083 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15084 the corresponding match text.
15085
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015086 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15087 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15088 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15089 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15090 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015091
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015092 Example :
15093
15094 # this is a comment and is ignored
15095 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15096 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15097 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15098 | | | `---------- value
15099 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15100 | `---------------------------- key
15101 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15102
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015103mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015104 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15105 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015106 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015107 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015108 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015109 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15110 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15111 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15112 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015113 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015114 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015115
15116mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015117 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015118 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15119 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015120 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015121 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015122 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015123 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15124 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15125 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15126 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015127 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015128 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015129
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015130nbsrv
15131 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15132 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15133 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15134 map lookup.
15135
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015136neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015137 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15138 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15139 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15140 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015141
15142not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015143 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015144 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015145 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015146 absence of a flag).
15147
15148odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015149 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015150 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15151
15152or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015153 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015154 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015155 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15156 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015157 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015158 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15159 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15160 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15161 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015162 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015163 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015164
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015165protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15166 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15167 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15168 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15169 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15170 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15171 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15172 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15173 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15174 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15175 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15176 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15177
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015178regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015179 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15180 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15181 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15182 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15183 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15184 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15185 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15186 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15187 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015188 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15189 of characters with other ones.
15190
15191 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15192 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15193 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15194 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15195 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15196 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015197
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015198 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015199
15200 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15201 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15202 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015203 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015204
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015205 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15206 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15207
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015208 # capture groups and backreferences
15209 # both lines do the same.
15210 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15211 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15212
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015213capture-req(<id>)
15214 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15215 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15216
15217 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015218 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15219 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015220
15221capture-res(<id>)
15222 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15223 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15224
15225 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015226 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15227 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015228
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015229rtrim(<chars>)
15230 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15231 of the input sample.
15232
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015233sdbm([<avalanche>])
15234 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15235 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15236 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15237 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15238 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15239 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15240 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015241 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15242 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015243
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015244secure_memcmp(<var>)
15245 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15246 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15247 match.
15248
15249 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15250 performed in constant time.
15251
15252 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15253 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15254
15255 Example :
15256
15257 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15258 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15259 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15260 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15261
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015262set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015263 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15264 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15265 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015266 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015267 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15268 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015269 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015270 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15271 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015272 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015273 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015274
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015275sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015276 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015277 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15278
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015279sha2([<bits>])
15280 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15281 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15282
15283 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15284 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15285
15286 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15287 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15288
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015289srv_queue
15290 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15291 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15292 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15293 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15294 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15295
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015296strcmp(<var>)
15297 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15298 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15299 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15300 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15301 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15302 shorter).
15303
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015304 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15305 strings in constant time.
15306
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015307 Example :
15308
15309 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15310 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15311 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15312
15313
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015314sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015315 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15316 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015317 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015318 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15319 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015320 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015321 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15322 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015323 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015324 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15325 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015326 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015327 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015328
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015329table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15330 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15331 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15332 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15333 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15334 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15335 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15336
15337
15338table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15339 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15340 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15341 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15342 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15343 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15344 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15345
15346table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15347 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15348 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015349 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015350 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15351 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15352
15353table_conn_cur(<table>)
15354 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15355 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15356 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15357 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15358 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15359
15360table_conn_rate(<table>)
15361 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15362 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15363 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15364 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15365 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15366
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015367table_gpt0(<table>)
15368 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15369 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15370 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15371 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15372 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15373
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015374table_gpc0(<table>)
15375 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15376 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15377 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15378 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15379 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15380
15381table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15382 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15383 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15384 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15385 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15386 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15387 sample fetch keyword.
15388
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015389table_gpc1(<table>)
15390 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15391 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15392 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15393 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15394 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15395
15396table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15397 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15398 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15399 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15400 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15401 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15402 sample fetch keyword.
15403
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015404table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15405 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15406 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015407 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015408 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15409 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15410
15411table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15412 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15413 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15414 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15415 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15416 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15417 keyword.
15418
15419table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15420 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15421 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015422 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015423 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15424 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15425
15426table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15427 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15428 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15429 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15430 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15431 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15432 keyword.
15433
15434table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15435 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15436 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015437 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015438 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15439 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15440 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15441 keyword.
15442
15443table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15444 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15445 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015446 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015447 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15448 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15449 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15450 keyword.
15451
15452table_server_id(<table>)
15453 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15454 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15455 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15456 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15457 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15458 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15459
15460table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15461 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15462 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015463 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015464 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15465 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15466 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15467 keyword.
15468
15469table_sess_rate(<table>)
15470 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15471 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15472 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15473 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15474 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15475 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15476 keyword.
15477
15478table_trackers(<table>)
15479 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15480 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15481 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15482 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15483 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15484 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15485 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15486 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15487 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15488 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15489
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015490upper
15491 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15492 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15493 type. The result is of type string.
15494
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015495url_dec([<in_form>])
15496 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15497 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15498 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15499 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15500 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15501 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015502
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015503ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015504 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015505 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15506 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15507 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015508 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15509 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15510 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15511 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015512 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015513 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15514 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015515
15516 Example:
15517 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15518 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15519
15520 message Point {
15521 int32 latitude = 1;
15522 int32 longitude = 2;
15523 }
15524
15525 message PPoint {
15526 Point point = 59;
15527 }
15528
15529 message Rectangle {
15530 // One corner of the rectangle.
15531 PPoint lo = 48;
15532 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15533 PPoint hi = 49;
15534 }
15535
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015536 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15537 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15538 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015539
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015540 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15541 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015542 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015543 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15544
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015545 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015546
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015547 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015548
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015549 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15550 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15551 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015552
15553 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15554 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15555 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15556
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015557 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15558 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15559 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015560
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015561
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015562unset-var(<var name>)
15563 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15564 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15565 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15566 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15567 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15568 response),
15569 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15570 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15571 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15572 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15573
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015574utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15575 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15576 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15577 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15578 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15579 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15580 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15581
15582 Example :
15583
15584 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015585 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015586 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15587
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015588word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15589 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15590 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15591 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015592 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015593 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15594 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15595
15596 Example :
15597 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15598 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15599 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15600 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15601 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015602 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015603
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015604wt6([<avalanche>])
15605 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15606 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15607 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15608 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15609 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15610 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15611 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015612 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15613 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015614
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015615xor(<value>)
15616 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015617 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015618 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015619 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015620 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015621 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15622 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015623 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015624 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15625 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015626 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015627 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015628
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015629xxh32([<seed>])
15630 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15631 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15632 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15633 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15634 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15635 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15636 as cryptographically secure.
15637
15638xxh64([<seed>])
15639 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15640 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15641 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15642 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15643 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15644 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15645 as cryptographically secure.
15646
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015647
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156487.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649--------------------------------------------
15650
15651A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15652not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15653"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15654The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15655
15656always_false : boolean
15657 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15658 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15659
15660always_true : boolean
15661 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15662 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15663
15664avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015665 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15667 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15668 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15669 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15670 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15671 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15672 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15673 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15674 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15675 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15676 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15677 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15678 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015681 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15682 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15683 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15684 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015685 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15686
15687be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15688 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15689 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15690 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15691 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15692 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015693 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15694 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015695
15696 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15697 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15698 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15701 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15702 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15703 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015704 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15706 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015707
15708 Example :
15709 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15710 backend dynamic
15711 mode http
15712 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15713 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015714
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015715bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015716 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15717 of the string.
15718
15719bool(<bool>) : bool
15720 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15721 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15724 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015725 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15727 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015728
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015729 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015730 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015731 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15732
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015733 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15734 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015735
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015736 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015737 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015739 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015740 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015742 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015743
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015744 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15745 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015747 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015748
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015749cpu_calls : integer
15750 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15751 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15752 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15753 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15754 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15755 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15756
15757cpu_ns_avg : integer
15758 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15759 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15760 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15761 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15762 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15763 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15764 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15765 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15766 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15767 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15768 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15769
15770cpu_ns_tot : integer
15771 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15772 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15773 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15774 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15775 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15776 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15777 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15778 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15779 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15780 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15781 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15782 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15783 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15784
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015785date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015786 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015787
15788 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15789 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15790 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015791 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15792
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015793 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15794 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15795 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15796 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15797 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15798
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015799 Example :
15800
15801 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15802 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015803
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015804 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15805 # millisecond granularity
15806 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15807
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015808date_us : integer
15809 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15810 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15811 from the same timeval structure.
15812
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015813distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15814 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15815 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15816 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15817 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15818 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15819 list of supported tokens.
15820
15821distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15822 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15823 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15824 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15825 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15826 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15827 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15828 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15829 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15830 supported tokens.
15831
15832 Example :
15833 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15834 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15835 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15836 # send large files to the big farm
15837 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15838
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015839env(<name>) : string
15840 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15841 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15842 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15843 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15844 certain way.
15845
15846 Examples :
15847 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15848 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15849
15850 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15851 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015853fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15854 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015855 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15856 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15858 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015859 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015860 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15861 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015862
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015863fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15864 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15865 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15866 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015868fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15869 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15870 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15871 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15872 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15873 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15874 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15875 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15876 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015877
15878 Example :
15879 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15880 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15881 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15882 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15883 frontend mail
15884 bind :25
15885 mode tcp
15886 maxconn 100
15887 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15888 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15889 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15890 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015891
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015892hostname : string
15893 Returns the system hostname.
15894
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015895int(<integer>) : signed integer
15896 Returns a signed integer.
15897
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015898ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15899 Returns an ipv4.
15900
15901ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15902 Returns an ipv6.
15903
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015904lat_ns_avg : integer
15905 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15906 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15907 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15908 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15909 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15910 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15911 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15912 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15913 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015914 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15915 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15916 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15917 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15918 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
15919 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015920
15921lat_ns_tot : integer
15922 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15923 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15924 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15925 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15926 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15927 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15928 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15929 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15930 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015931 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15932 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15933 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15934 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15935 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015936 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15937 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15938 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15939 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15940 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15941 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15942
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015943meth(<method>) : method
15944 Returns a method.
15945
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015946nbproc : integer
15947 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15948 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15949 and debugging purposes.
15950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15952 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15953 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15954 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015955 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15956 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15957 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015958
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015959prio_class : integer
15960 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15961 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15962 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15963
15964prio_offset : integer
15965 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15966 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15967 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15968 set-priority-offset".
15969
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015970proc : integer
15971 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15972 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15973 debugging purposes.
15974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015976 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15977 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15978 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15980 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15981 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15982 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15983 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15984
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015985rand([<range>]) : integer
15986 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15987 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15988 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15989 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15990 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15991
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015992uuid([<version>]) : string
15993 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15994 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15995 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15998 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15999 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16000 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16001 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16002 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016003 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16004 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16005
16006srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16007 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16008 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16009 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16010 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16011 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16012 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16013 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16014
16015 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16016 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017
16018srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16019 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16020 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16021 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016022 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16024 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16025 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16026
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016027srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16028 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16029 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16030 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16031 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16032 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16033 fetch methods.
16034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16036 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16037 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016038 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016039 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16040 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016041 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016042 overloading servers).
16043
16044 Example :
16045 # Redirect to a separate back
16046 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16047 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16048 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16049
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016050stopping : boolean
16051 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16052 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16053 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16054
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016055str(<string>) : string
16056 Returns a string.
16057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16059 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16060 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16061
16062table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16063 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16064 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16065 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16066
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016067thread : integer
16068 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16069 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16070 and debugging purposes.
16071
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016072var(<var-name>) : undefined
16073 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016074 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16075 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016076 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016077 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16078 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016079 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016080 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16081 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016082 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016083 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016084
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160857.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086----------------------------------
16087
16088The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16089closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16090methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16091sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16092TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016093the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16094counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016095"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16096used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16097can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16098Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16099table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16100tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16101currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016103bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016104 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16105 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16106 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108be_id : integer
16109 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016110 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16111 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016113be_name : string
16114 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016115 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16116 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118dst : ip
16119 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16120 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16121 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16122 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016123 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16124 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16125 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16126 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16127 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16128 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129
16130dst_conn : integer
16131 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16132 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16133 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16134 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16135 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16136 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16137 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16138 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016139
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016140dst_is_local : boolean
16141 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16142 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16143 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16144 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016145 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016146 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16147 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16148 it only once per connection.
16149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016150dst_port : integer
16151 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16152 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16153 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16154 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16155 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16156 an HTTP header.
16157
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016158fc_http_major : integer
16159 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16160 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16161 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16162
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016163fc_pp_authority : string
16164 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16165 if any.
16166
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016167fc_pp_unique_id : string
16168 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16169 if any.
16170
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016171fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16172 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16173 header.
16174
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016175fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16176 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16177 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16178 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16179 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16180 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16181 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16182
16183fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16184 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16185 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16186 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16187 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16188 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16189 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16190
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016191fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016192 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16193 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16194 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16195 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16196
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016197fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016198 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16199 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16200 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16201 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16202
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016203fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016204 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16205 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16206 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16207 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16208
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016209fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016210 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16211 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16212 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16213 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16214
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016215fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016216 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16217 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16218 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16219 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16220
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016221fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016222 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16223 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16224 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16225 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16226
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016227fe_defbe : string
16228 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16229 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231fe_id : integer
16232 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016233 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016234 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16235
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016236fe_name : string
16237 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16238 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16239 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16240
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016241sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016242sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16243sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16244sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016245 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16246 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16247 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16248
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016249sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016250sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16251sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16252sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016253 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16254 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16255 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16256
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016257sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016258sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16259sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16260sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016261 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16262 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016263 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16264 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16265 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016266
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016267 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016268 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16269 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016270 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16271 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16272 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016273 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16274 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16275
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016276sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16277sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16278sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16279sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16280 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16281 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16282 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16283 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16284 when a first ACL was verified.
16285
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016286sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016287sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16288sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16289sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016290 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016291 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16292
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016293sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016294sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16295sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16296sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016297 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16298 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16299 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16300
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016301sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016302sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16303sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16304sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016305 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16306 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16307 See also src_conn_rate.
16308
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016309sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016310sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16311sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16312sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016313 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016314 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016315
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016316sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16317sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16318sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16319sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16320 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16321 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16322
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016323sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16324sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16325sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16326sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16327 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16328 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16329
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016330sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016331sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16332sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16333sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016334 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16335 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16336 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016337 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16338 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16339 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016340
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016341sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16342sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16343sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16344sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16345 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16346 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16347 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16348 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16349 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16350 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016352sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016353sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16354sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16355sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016356 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016357 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16358 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16359
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016360sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016361sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16362sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16363sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016364 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16365 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16366 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16367 src_http_err_rate.
16368
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016369sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016370sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16371sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16372sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016373 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016374 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16375 src_http_req_cnt.
16376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016377sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016378sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16379sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16380sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016381 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16382 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16383 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16384 src_http_req_rate.
16385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016386sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016387sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16388sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16389sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016390 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016391 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16392 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16393 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16394 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016395
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016396 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016397 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16398 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016399 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16400
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016401sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16402sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16403sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16404sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16405 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16406 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16407 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16408 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16409 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16410
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016411sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016412sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16413sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16414sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016415 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16416 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16417 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016419sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016420sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16421sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16422sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016423 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16424 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16425 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016427sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016428sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16429sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16430sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016431 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016432 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16433 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16434 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016435 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016436 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16437
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016438sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016439sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16440sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16441sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016442 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16443 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16444 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16445 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16446 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016447 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016448
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016449sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016450sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16451sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16452sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016453 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16454 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16455 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16456
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016457sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016458sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16459sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16460sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016461 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16462 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016463 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016464 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16465 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016466 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16467 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16468 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016470so_id : integer
16471 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16472 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16473 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016474
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016475so_name : string
16476 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16477 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16478 strings instead of integers.
16479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016481 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016482 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16483 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16484 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016485 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16486 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16487 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016488 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16489 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16490 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16491 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16492 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16493 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16494 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016495
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016496 Example:
16497 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16498 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016500src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16501 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16502 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16503 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016504 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016506src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16507 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16508 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016509 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016510 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016512src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16513 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16514 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16515 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16516 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16517 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16518 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016519
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016520 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016521 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16522 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16523 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16524 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016525 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016526 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16527 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16528
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016529src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16530 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16531 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16532 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16533 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16534 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16535 was verified.
16536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016537src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016538 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016539 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016540 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016541 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016544 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016545 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16546 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016547 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016549src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16550 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16551 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16552 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016553 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016555src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016556 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016557 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016558 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016559 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016560
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016561src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16562 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16563 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16564 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16565 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16566
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016567src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16568 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16569 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16570 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16571 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016573src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016574 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016576 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16577 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016578 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16579 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16580 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016581
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016582src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16583 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16584 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16585 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16586 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16587 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16588 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16589 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016591src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016592 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016594 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016595 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016596 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016598src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16599 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16600 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16601 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16602 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016603 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016606 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016607 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16608 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016609 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016611src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16612 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16613 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16614 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016615 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016616 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016618src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16619 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16620 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16621 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016622 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16624 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016625
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016626 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016627 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016628 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016629 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016630
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016631src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16632 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16633 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16634 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16635 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16636 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16637 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16638
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016639src_is_local : boolean
16640 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16641 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16642 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16643 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016644 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016645 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16646 once per connection.
16647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016648src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016649 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16650 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16651 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16652 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16653 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016655src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016656 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16657 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16658 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16659 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16660 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016662src_port : integer
16663 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16664 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16665 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16666 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016668src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016669 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016670 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16671 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16672 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016673 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016675src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16676 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16677 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16678 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16679 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016680 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016682src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16683 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16684 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16685 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16686 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16687 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16688 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16689 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16690 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016691
16692 Example :
16693 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16694 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16695 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16696 listen ssh
16697 bind :22
16698 mode tcp
16699 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016700 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016701 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016702 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016704srv_id : integer
16705 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16706 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016707 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016708
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016709srv_name : string
16710 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16711 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016712 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016713
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167147.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016715----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016717The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16718closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16719when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16720usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016721future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016722
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001672351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16724 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16725 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16726 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16727 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16728 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16729
16730 Example :
16731 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16732 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16733 # the request.
16734 frontend http-in
16735 bind *:8081
16736 default_backend servers
16737 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16738 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16739
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016740ssl_bc : boolean
16741 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16742 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016743 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16744 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016745
16746ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16747 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016748 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16749 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016750
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016751ssl_bc_alpn : string
16752 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16753 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016754 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016755 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16756 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16757 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16758 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16759 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016760 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16761 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016762
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016763ssl_bc_cipher : string
16764 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016765 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16766 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016767
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016768ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16769 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16770 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16771 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016772 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016773
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016774ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16775 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16776 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016777 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16778 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016779
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016780ssl_bc_npn : string
16781 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16782 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016783 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016784 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16785 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16786 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16787 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016788 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16789 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016790
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016791ssl_bc_protocol : string
16792 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016793 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16794 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016795
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016796ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016797 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016798 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016799 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16800 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016801
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016802ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16803 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16804 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16805 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016806 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016807
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016808ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16809 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16810 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016811 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16812 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016813
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016814ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16815 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16816 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16817 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016818 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016819
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016820ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16821 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016822 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16823 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016825ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16826 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16827 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16828 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16829 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16830 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16833 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16834 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16835 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16836 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016837
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016838ssl_c_der : binary
16839 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16840 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16841 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016843ssl_c_err : integer
16844 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16845 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16846 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16847 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16848 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016849
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016850ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016851 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16852 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16853 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16854 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16855 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16856 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16857 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16858 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016859 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16860 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16861 LDAP v3.
16862 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16863 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016865ssl_c_key_alg : string
16866 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16867 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16868 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016870ssl_c_notafter : string
16871 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16872 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16873 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016875ssl_c_notbefore : string
16876 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16877 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16878 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016879
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016880ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016881 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16882 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16883 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16884 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16885 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16886 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16887 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16888 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016889 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16890 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16891 LDAP v3.
16892 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16893 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895ssl_c_serial : binary
16896 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16897 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16898 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016900ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16901 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16902 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16903 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016904 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16905 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16906
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016907 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016908 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016910ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16911 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16912 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16913 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016915ssl_c_used : boolean
16916 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16917 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016919ssl_c_verify : integer
16920 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16921 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16922 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16923 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016925ssl_c_version : integer
16926 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16927 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016928
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016929ssl_f_der : binary
16930 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16931 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16932 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16933
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016934ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016935 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16936 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16937 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16938 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016939 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016940 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16941 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16942 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016943 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16944 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16945 LDAP v3.
16946 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16947 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016949ssl_f_key_alg : string
16950 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16951 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16952 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016954ssl_f_notafter : string
16955 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16956 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16957 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016959ssl_f_notbefore : string
16960 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16961 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16962 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016963
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016964ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016965 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16966 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16967 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16968 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16969 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16970 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16971 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16972 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016973 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16974 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16975 LDAP v3.
16976 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16977 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016979ssl_f_serial : binary
16980 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16981 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16982 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016983
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016984ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16985 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16986 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16987 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016989ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16990 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16991 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16992 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016994ssl_f_version : integer
16995 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16996 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16997
16998ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016999 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17000 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17001 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017003 Example :
17004 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17005 listen http-https
17006 bind :80
17007 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17008 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17009
17010ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17011 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17012 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17013
17014ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017015 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017016 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17017 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17018 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17019 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17020 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17021 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17022 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17023 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017025ssl_fc_cipher : string
17026 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17027 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017028
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017029ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17030 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17031 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017032 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017033
17034ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17035 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17036 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017037 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017038
17039ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17040 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17041 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17042 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017043 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017044 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017045
17046ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17047 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17048 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017049 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017050
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017051ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17052 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17053 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17054 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17055
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017056ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17057 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17058 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17059 transport layer.
17060 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17061 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17062 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17063 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17064
17065ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17066 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17067 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17068 transport layer.
17069 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17070 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17071 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17072 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17073
17074ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17075 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17076 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17077 transport layer.
17078 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17079 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17080 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17081 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17082
17083ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17084 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17085 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17086 transport layer.
17087 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17088 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17089 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17090 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17091
17092ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17093 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17094 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17095 transport layer.
17096 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17097 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17098 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17099 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017101ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017102 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17103 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017104 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17105 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17106 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17107 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017108
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017109ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17110 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17111 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17112 wait until the handshake happened.
17113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017114ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17115 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017116 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17117 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017118 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017119 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017120
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017121ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017122 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017123 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17124 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017126ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017127 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017128 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17129 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17130 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17131 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17132 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17133 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17134 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017136ssl_fc_protocol : string
17137 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17138 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017139
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017140ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017141 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017142 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17143 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017144
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017145ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17146 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17147 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17148 transport layer.
17149 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17150 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17151 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17152 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17153
17154ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17155 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17156 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17157 transport layer.
17158 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17159 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17160 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17161 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17162
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017163ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17164 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17165 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17166 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017168ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17169 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17170 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17171 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17172 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017173
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017174ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17175 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17176 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17177 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17178 BoringSSL.
17179
17180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017181ssl_fc_sni : string
17182 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17183 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17184 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17185 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17186 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17187
17188 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17189 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17190 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017191 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017192 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017194 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017195 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17196 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017198ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17199 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17200 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017201
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017202ssl_s_der : binary
17203 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17204 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17205 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17206
17207ssl_s_key_alg : string
17208 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17209 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17210 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17211
17212ssl_s_notafter : string
17213 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17214 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17215 transport layer.
17216
17217ssl_s_notbefore : string
17218 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17219 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17220 transport layer.
17221
17222ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17223 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17224 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17225 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17226 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17227 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17228 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017229 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17230 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017231 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17232 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17233 LDAP v3.
17234 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17235 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17236
17237ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17238 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17239 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17240 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17241 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17242 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17243 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017244 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17245 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017246 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17247 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17248 LDAP v3.
17249 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17250 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17251
17252ssl_s_serial : binary
17253 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17254 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17255 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17256
17257ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17258 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17259 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17260 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17261
17262ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17263 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17264 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17265 layer.
17266
17267ssl_s_version : integer
17268 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17269 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017270
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172717.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017272------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017274Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17275sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17276only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17277For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17278be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17279can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17280sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17281for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17282content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017284payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017285 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017286 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17287 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017289payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17290 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017291 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017292 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017293
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017294req.hdrs : string
17295 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17296 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17297 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17298 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17299
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017300req.hdrs_bin : binary
17301 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17302 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17303 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17304 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17305 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17306 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17307
17308 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17309
17310 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17311 str: <int:length><bytes>
17312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017313req.len : integer
17314req_len : integer (deprecated)
17315 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17316 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17317 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17318 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17319 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17320 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17321 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17322 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017324req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17325 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017326 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17327 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17328 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17329 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331 ACL alternatives :
17332 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017334req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17335 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17336 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17337 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17338 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017340 ACL alternatives :
17341 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017343 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017345req.proto_http : boolean
17346req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17347 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17348 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17349 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17350 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17351 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17352 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17353 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355 Example:
17356 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17357 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17358 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017359 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017361req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17362rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17363 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17364 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17365 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17366 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17367 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17368 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17369 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017371 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17372 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17373 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17374 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17375 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17376 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017378 ACL derivatives :
17379 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381 Example :
17382 listen tse-farm
17383 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17384 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17385 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17386 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17387 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17388 persist rdp-cookie
17389 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17390 # This is only useful makes sense if
17391 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17392 stick-table type string size 204800
17393 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17394 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17395 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17398 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017400req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17401rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17402 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17403 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17404 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17405 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017407 ACL derivatives :
17408 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017409
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017410req.ssl_alpn : string
17411 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17412 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17413 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17414 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17415 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17416 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017417 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017418
17419 Examples :
17420 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17421 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17422 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017423 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017424 default_backend bk_default
17425
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017426req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17427 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17428 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017429 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17430 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17431 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17432 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17433 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017435req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17436req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17437 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17438 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17439 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17440 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17441 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17442 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17443 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017445req.ssl_sni : string
17446req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17447 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17448 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17449 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17450 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17451 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17452 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17453 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17454 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17455 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17456 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17457 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17458 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017460 ACL derivatives :
17461 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017463 Examples :
17464 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17465 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17466 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17467 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17468 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017469
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017470req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17471 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17472 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17473 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17474 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17475 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17476 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17477 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17478 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17479 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017481req.ssl_ver : integer
17482req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17483 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17484 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17485 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17486 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17487 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17488 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17489 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017490 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017491 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017493 ACL derivatives :
17494 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017495
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017496res.len : integer
17497 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17498 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17499 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17500 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17501 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17502 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17503 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017504 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017506res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17507 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017508 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017509 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017510 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017511 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017513res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17514 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17515 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17516 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017517 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17518 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017520 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017521
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017522res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17523rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17524 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17525 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17526 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17527 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17528 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17529 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17530 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017532wait_end : boolean
17533 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17534 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017535 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017536 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17537 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017538 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017539 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17540 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017542 Examples :
17543 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17544 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17545 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017547 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17548 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17549 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17550 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17551 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17552 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17553 tcp-request content reject
17554
17555
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175567.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557--------------------------------------
17558
17559It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17560This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17561data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17562its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17563HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17564content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17565to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17566more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17567response are indexed.
17568
17569base : string
17570 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17571 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17572 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17573 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17574 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17575 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17576 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17577 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17578
17579 ACL derivatives :
17580 base : exact string match
17581 base_beg : prefix match
17582 base_dir : subdir match
17583 base_dom : domain match
17584 base_end : suffix match
17585 base_len : length match
17586 base_reg : regex match
17587 base_sub : substring match
17588
17589base32 : integer
17590 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17591 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17592 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017593 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17594 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17595 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596
17597base32+src : binary
17598 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17599 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17600 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17601 per-URL counters.
17602
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017603capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17604 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17605 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17606 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17607
17608capture.req.method : string
17609 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17610 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17611 because it's allocated.
17612
17613capture.req.uri : string
17614 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17615 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17616 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17617 allocated.
17618
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017619capture.req.ver : string
17620 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17621 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17622 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17623
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017624capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17625 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17626 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17627 The first entry is an index of 0.
17628 See also: "capture response header"
17629
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017630capture.res.ver : string
17631 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17632 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17633 persistent flag.
17634
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017635req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017636 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17637 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17638 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017639
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017640req.body_param([<name>) : string
17641 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17642 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17643 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17644 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17645 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17646 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17647 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17648 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17649 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17650 given.
17651
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017652req.body_len : integer
17653 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17654 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017655 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17656 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017657
17658req.body_size : integer
17659 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017660 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17661 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017663req.cook([<name>]) : string
17664cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17665 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17666 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17667 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17668 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17669 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17670 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17671 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17672 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17673
17674 ACL derivatives :
17675 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17676 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17677 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17678 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17679 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17680 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17681 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17682 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017684req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17685cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17686 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17687 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017689req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17690cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17691 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17692 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17693 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17694 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017696cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17697 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17698 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17699 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17700 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017701 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017702 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17703 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17704 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17705 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017707hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17708 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17709 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17710 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17711 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017712 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017714req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17715 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17716 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17717 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17718 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17719 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17720 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17721 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17722 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017724req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17725 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17726 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17727 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17728 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17731 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17732 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17733 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17734 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17735 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17736 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17737 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17738 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017739 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017740 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017741 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743 ACL derivatives :
17744 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17745 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17746 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17747 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17748 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17749 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17750 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17751 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17752
17753req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17754hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17755 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17756 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17757 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17758 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17759 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17760 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17761 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17762 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17763 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17764
17765req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17766hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17767 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17768 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17769 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17770 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17771 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017772 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017773 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17774 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17775
17776req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17777hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17778 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17779 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17780 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17781 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17782 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17783 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17784 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17785
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017786
17787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017788http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17789 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17790 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17791 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17792 basic auth is supported.
17793
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017794http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17795 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17796 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17797 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17798 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017799 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17800 basic auth is supported.
17801
17802 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017803 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17804 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17805 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17806 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017807
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017808http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017809 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17810 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17811 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017812
17813http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017814 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17815 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17816 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017817
17818http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017819 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17820 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17821 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017823http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017824 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17825 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017826 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17827 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017829method : integer + string
17830 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17831 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17832 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17833 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17834 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17835 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17836 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017838 ACL derivatives :
17839 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017841 Example :
17842 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17843 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17844 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017846path : string
17847 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17848 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17849 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17850 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17851 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017852 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017853 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017855 ACL derivatives :
17856 path : exact string match
17857 path_beg : prefix match
17858 path_dir : subdir match
17859 path_dom : domain match
17860 path_end : suffix match
17861 path_len : length match
17862 path_reg : regex match
17863 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017864
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017865query : string
17866 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17867 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17868 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17869 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017870 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017871 which stops before the question mark.
17872
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017873req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17874 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17875 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17876 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17877 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017879req.ver : string
17880req_ver : string (deprecated)
17881 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17882 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17883 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017885 ACL derivatives :
17886 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017887
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017888res.body : binary
17889 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17890 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17891 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17892 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17893
17894res.body_len : integer
17895 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17896 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17897 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17898 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17899
17900res.body_size : integer
17901 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17902 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17903 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17904 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17905 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17906 based expect rules.
17907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017908res.comp : boolean
17909 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17910 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17911 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017913res.comp_algo : string
17914 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17915 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17916 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017918res.cook([<name>]) : string
17919scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17920 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17921 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017922 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17923 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017925 ACL derivatives :
17926 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017928res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17929scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17930 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17931 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017932 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17933 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017935res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17936scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17937 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17938 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017939 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17940 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017942res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17943 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17944 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17945 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17946 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17947 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17948 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17949 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17950 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017951 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017953res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17954 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17955 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17956 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17957 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017958 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17959 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017961res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17962shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17963 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17964 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17965 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17966 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17967 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17968 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17969 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017970 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17971 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017973 ACL derivatives :
17974 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17975 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17976 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17977 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17978 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17979 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17980 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17981 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17982
17983res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17984shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17985 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17986 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17987 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17988 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017989 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017991res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17992shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17993 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17994 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17995 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17996 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17997 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017998 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17999 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018000
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018001res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18002 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18003 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18004 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018005 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18006 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018008res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18009shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18010 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18011 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18012 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18013 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18014 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018015 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18016 based expect rules.
18017
18018res.hdrs : string
18019 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18020 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18021 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18022 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18023 based expect rules.
18024
18025res.hdrs_bin : binary
18026 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18027 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18028 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18029 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18030 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18031 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18032 (length of 0 for both).
18033
18034 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18035
18036 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18037 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018039res.ver : string
18040resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18041 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018042 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18043 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018045 ACL derivatives :
18046 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018048set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18049 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18050 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018051 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018052 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018054 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18055 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018057status : integer
18058 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18059 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018060 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18061 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018062
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018063unique-id : string
18064 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18065 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18066 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18067 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18068 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18069 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018071url : string
18072 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18073 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18074 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18075 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18076 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18077 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18078 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018080 ACL derivatives :
18081 url : exact string match
18082 url_beg : prefix match
18083 url_dir : subdir match
18084 url_dom : domain match
18085 url_end : suffix match
18086 url_len : length match
18087 url_reg : regex match
18088 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018090url_ip : ip
18091 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18092 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18093 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18094 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18095 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18096 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18097 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018099url_port : integer
18100 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18101 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18102 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18103 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018104
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018105urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18106url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018107 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18108 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018109 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18110 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18111 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18112 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018113 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18114 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018115 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18116 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018118 ACL derivatives :
18119 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18120 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18121 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18122 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18123 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18124 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18125 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18126 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018127
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018129 Example :
18130 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18131 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18132 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18133 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018134
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018135urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018136 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18137 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18138 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018139
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018140url32 : integer
18141 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18142 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18143 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18144 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18145 is an unsigned integer.
18146
18147url32+src : binary
18148 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18149 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18150 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18151
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018152
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200181537.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018154---------------------------------------
18155
18156This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18157used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18158purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18159There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18160or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18161any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18162for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18163
18164internal.htx.data : integer
18165 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18166 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18167
18168internal.htx.free : integer
18169 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18170 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18171
18172internal.htx.free_data : integer
18173 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18174 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18175
18176internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18177 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18178 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18179 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18180
18181internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18182 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18183 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18184
18185internal.htx.size : integer
18186 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18187 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18188
18189internal.htx.used : integer
18190 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18191 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18192 direction.
18193
18194internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18195 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18196 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18197 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18198 of the special value :
18199 * head : The oldest inserted block
18200 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018201 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018202
18203internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18204 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18205 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18206 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18207 integer or one of the special value :
18208 * head : The oldest inserted block
18209 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018210 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018211
18212internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18213 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18214 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18215 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18216 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18217
18218 * head : The oldest inserted block
18219 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018220 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018221
18222internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18223 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18224 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18225 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18226 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18227
18228 * head : The oldest inserted block
18229 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018230 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018231
18232internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18233 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18234 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18235 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18236 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18237
18238 * head : The oldest inserted block
18239 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018240 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018241
18242internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18243 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18244 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18245 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18246 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18247
18248 * head : The oldest inserted block
18249 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018250 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018251
18252internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18253 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18254 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18255 it returns false.
18256
18257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200182587.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018259---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018261Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18262every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018263order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018265ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18266---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018267FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018268HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018269HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18270HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018271HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18272HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18273HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18274HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18275LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018276METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018277METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018278METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18279METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18280METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18281METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018282METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018283METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018284RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018285REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018286TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018287WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18288---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018289
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182918. Logging
18292----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018293
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018294One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18295provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18296very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18297provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18298state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018299to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018300headers.
18301
18302In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18303about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18304send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18305
18306 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18307 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18308 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18309 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18310 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018311 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018312 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018313
18314The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18315allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18316as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18317while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18318real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18319delay.
18320
18321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183228.1. Log levels
18323---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018324
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018325TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018326source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018327HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18328in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18329track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18330syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18331about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018332
18333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183348.2. Log formats
18335----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018336
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018337HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018338and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18339slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18340options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018341
18342 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18343 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18344 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18345 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18346 extents.
18347
18348 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18349 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18350 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18351 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18352 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18353
18354 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18355 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18356 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18357 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18358 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18359
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018360 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18361 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18362 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18363 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18364
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018365 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18366
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018367Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18368specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18369field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18370servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18371always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18372identifier.
18373
18374Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18375 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18376 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18377 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18378 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18379
18380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183818.2.1. Default log format
18382-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018383
18384This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18385as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18386format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18387
18388 Example :
18389 listen www
18390 mode http
18391 log global
18392 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18393
18394 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18395 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18396 (www/HTTP)
18397
18398 Field Format Extract from the example above
18399 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18400 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18401 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18402 4 'to' to
18403 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18404 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18405
18406Detailed fields description :
18407 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18408 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18409 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18410 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18411 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18412 and processed the connection.
18413 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18414
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018415In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18416"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18417connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018419It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18420will eventually disappear.
18421
18422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184238.2.2. TCP log format
18424---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018425
18426The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18427is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18428information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18429counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18430emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18431environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18432the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18433sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018434specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18435not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18436fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18437marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018438
18439 Example :
18440 frontend fnt
18441 mode tcp
18442 option tcplog
18443 log global
18444 default_backend bck
18445
18446 backend bck
18447 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18448
18449 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18450 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18451 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18452
18453 Field Format Extract from the example above
18454 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18455 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18456 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18457 4 frontend_name fnt
18458 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18459 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18460 7 bytes_read* 212
18461 8 termination_state --
18462 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18463 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18464
18465Detailed fields description :
18466 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018467 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18468 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18469 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018470 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018471 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018472 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018473
18474 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018475 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18476 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18477 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018478
18479 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18480 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18481 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018482 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18483 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18484 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18485 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018486
18487 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18488 and processed the connection.
18489
18490 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18491 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18492 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18493 applications.
18494
18495 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18496 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18497 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18498 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18499 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18500
18501 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18502 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18503 See "Timers" below for more details.
18504
18505 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18506 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18507 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18508 "Timers" below for more details.
18509
18510 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018511 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018512 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18513 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18514 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18515 details.
18516
18517 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18518 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18519 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18520 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18521 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18522
18523 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18524 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18525 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18526 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18527 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18528 for more details.
18529
18530 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018531 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018532 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18533 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18534 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018535 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018536
18537 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18538 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18539 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18540 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18541 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18542 caused by a denial of service attack.
18543
18544 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18545 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18546 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18547 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18548 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18549 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18550 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18551 denial of service attack.
18552
18553 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18554 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18555 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18556 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18557 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18558 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18559 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18560 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18561 be processed than on other servers.
18562
18563 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18564 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18565 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18566 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18567 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18568 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18569 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18570 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18571 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18572 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18573 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18574 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18575 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18576
18577 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18578 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18579 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18580 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18581 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18582 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018583 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018584 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18585
18586 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18587 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18588 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18589 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18590 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18591 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018592 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018593 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18594 occurs.
18595
18596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185978.2.3. HTTP log format
18598----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018599
18600The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18601is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18602the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18603are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18604emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18605generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18606"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18607which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018608frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18609is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018610
18611Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18612slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18613with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18614
18615 Example :
18616 frontend http-in
18617 mode http
18618 option httplog
18619 log global
18620 default_backend bck
18621
18622 backend static
18623 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18624
18625 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18626 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18627 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018628 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018629
18630 Field Format Extract from the example above
18631 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18632 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018633 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018634 4 frontend_name http-in
18635 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018636 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018637 7 status_code 200
18638 8 bytes_read* 2750
18639 9 captured_request_cookie -
18640 10 captured_response_cookie -
18641 11 termination_state ----
18642 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18643 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18644 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18645 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18646 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018647
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018648Detailed fields description :
18649 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018650 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18651 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18652 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018653 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018654 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018655 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018656
18657 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018658 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18659 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18660 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018661
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018662 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18663 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018664
18665 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18666 and processed the connection.
18667
18668 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18669 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18670 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18671
18672 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18673 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18674 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18675 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18676 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18677 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18678
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018679 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18680 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18681 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018682 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018683 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18684 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018685 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18686 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018687
18688 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18689 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018690 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018691
18692 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18693 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018694 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18695 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018696
18697 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18698 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18699 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18700 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18701 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018702 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18703 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018704
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018705 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18706 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18707 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18708 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18709 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18710 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18711 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018712 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018713
18714 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18715 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18716 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18717
18718 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18719 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018720 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018721 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18722 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18723 overflowing.
18724
18725 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18726 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18727 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18728 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18729 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18730 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18731 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18732 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18733
18734 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18735 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18736 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18737 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18738 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18739 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18740 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18741 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18742
18743 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18744 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18745 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18746 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18747 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18748 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18749 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18750
18751 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018752 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018753 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18754 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18755 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018756 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018757 system.
18758
18759 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18760 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18761 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18762 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18763 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18764 caused by a denial of service attack.
18765
18766 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18767 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18768 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18769 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18770 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18771 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18772 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18773 denial of service attack.
18774
18775 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18776 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18777 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18778 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18779 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18780 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18781 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18782 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18783 processed than on other servers.
18784
18785 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18786 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18787 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18788 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18789 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18790 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18791 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18792 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18793 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18794 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18795 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18796 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18797 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18798
18799 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18800 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18801 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18802 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18803 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18804 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018805 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018806 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18807
18808 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18809 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18810 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18811 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18812 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18813 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018814 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018815 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18816 occurs.
18817
18818 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18819 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18820 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18821 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18822 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18823 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18824 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18825 cookies" below for more details.
18826
18827 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18828 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18829 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18830 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18831 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18832 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18833 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18834 and cookies" below for more details.
18835
18836 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18837 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18838 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18839 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18840 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18841 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18842 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18843 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18844
18845
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200188468.2.4. Custom log format
18847------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018848
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018849The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018850mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018852HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018853Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18854separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18855prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18856
18857Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18858variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018859("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018860
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018861If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018862as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018863less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18864the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18865
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020018866Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
18867"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
18868delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
18869preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018870
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018871Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18872'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18873https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18874such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18875
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018876Flags are :
18877 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018878 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018879 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18880 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018881
18882 Example:
18883
18884 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18885 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18886
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018887 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18888
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018889At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18890
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018891 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18892 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018893
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018894the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018895
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018896 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18897 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18898 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018899
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018900and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18901
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018902 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18903 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018904
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018905Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18906
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018907 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018908 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018909 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18910 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18911 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018912 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18913 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18914 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018915 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018916 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18917 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018918 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018919 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18920 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018921 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018922 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018923 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018924 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018925 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018926 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018927 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018928 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18929 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18930 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18931 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18932 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018933 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018934 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018935 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018936 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018937 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018938 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18939 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018940 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18941 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18942 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018943 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018944 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18945 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018946 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018947 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18948 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18949 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018950 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018951 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018952 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18953 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18954 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18955 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018956 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018957 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018958 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018959 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018960 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018961 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018962 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18963 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18964 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018965 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018966 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18967 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018968 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018969 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18970 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018971 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018972 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018973 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018974 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018975
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018976 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018977
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018978
189798.2.5. Error log format
18980-----------------------
18981
18982When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18983protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18984By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18985"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018986will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018987logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18988
18989The format looks like this :
18990
18991 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18992 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18993 Connection error during SSL handshake
18994
18995 Field Format Extract from the example above
18996 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18997 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18998 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18999 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19000 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19001
19002These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19003failures.
19004
19005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190068.3. Advanced logging options
19007-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019008
19009Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19010just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19011options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19012for more information about their usage.
19013
19014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190158.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19016------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019017
19018It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19019haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19020commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19021monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19022ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19023
19024 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19025 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19026 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19027 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19028
19029 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
19030 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
19031 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019032 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019033 such as other load-balancers.
19034
19035 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19036 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19037 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19038
19039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190408.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19041----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019042
19043The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19044what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19045or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019046"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019047just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19048log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19049after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19050is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19051with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19052with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19053
19054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190558.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19056------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019057
19058Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19059for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19060"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19061retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19062raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19063a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19064file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19065you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19066"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19067
19068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190698.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19070--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019071
19072Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19073multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19074them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19075"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19076logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19077error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19078and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19079too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19080useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19081alternative.
19082
19083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190848.4. Timing events
19085------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019086
19087Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19088reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19089the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19090frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019091mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19092addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19093
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019094Timings events in HTTP mode:
19095
19096 first request 2nd request
19097 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19098 t tr t tr ...
19099 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19100 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19101 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19102 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019103 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019104 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19105
19106Timings events in TCP mode:
19107
19108 TCP session
19109 |<----------------->|
19110 t t
19111 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19112 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19113 |<------ Tt ------->|
19114
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019115 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019116 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019117 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19118 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19119 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019120 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019121 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19122 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19123 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19124 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019125
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019126 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19127 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19128 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019129 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19130 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19131 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19132 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19133 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19134 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019135
19136 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19137 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19138 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19139 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19140 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19141 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19142 request typed by hand during a test.
19143
19144 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19145 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019146 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019147 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19148 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19149 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19150 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019151
19152 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19153 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19154 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19155 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19156 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19157
19158 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19159 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19160 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19161 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19162 connection never established.
19163
19164 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19165 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19166 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19167 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19168 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19169 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19170 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19171 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19172 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19173 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19174 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19175
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019176 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19177 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19178 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19179 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19180 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19181 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19182
19183 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19184
19185 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19186 "Ta" can never be negative.
19187
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019188 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19189 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019190 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19191 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019192 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019193
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019194 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019195
19196 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019197 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19198 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019199
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019200 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19201 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19202 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19203 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19204 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19205 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19206 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19207 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19208
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019209These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19210protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19211that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019212due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19213"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19214that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019215
19216Most common cases :
19217
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019218 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19219 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19220 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19221 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19222 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19223 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19224 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19225 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19226 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19227 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19228 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019229 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019230
19231 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19232 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19233 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19234 of ms on remote networks.
19235
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019236 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19237 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19238 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019239
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019240 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19241 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19242 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19243 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19244 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19245 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19246 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19247 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19248 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019249
19250Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19251
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019252 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019253 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019254 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019255
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019256 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019257 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19258 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19259
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019260 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019261 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19262 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19263 flags.
19264
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019265 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19266 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019267 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19268 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19269 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19270 the client connection was maintained open.
19271
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019272 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019273 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019274 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019275 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19276
19277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192788.5. Session state at disconnection
19279-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019280
19281TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19282"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
192832-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19284each of which has a special meaning :
19285
19286 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19287 session to terminate :
19288
19289 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19290
19291 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19292 server explicitly refused it.
19293
19294 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19295 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19296 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19297 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019298 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019299
19300 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19301 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019302
19303 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19304 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19305 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19306 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19307 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19308
19309 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19310 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19311 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19312 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19313 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19314
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019315 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19316 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19317
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019318 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19319 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19320 backup connections when going up.
19321
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019322 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19323
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019324 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19325 send or receive data.
19326
19327 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19328 send or receive data.
19329
19330 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19331 with nothing left in the buffers.
19332
19333 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19334
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019335 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019336 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19337
19338 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19339 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19340 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19341 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19342 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19343
19344 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19345 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19346
19347 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19348 server (HTTP only).
19349
19350 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19351
19352 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19353 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19354 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19355
19356 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19357 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19358 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19359
19360 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19361
19362 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19363 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19364
19365 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19366 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19367 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19368
19369 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19370 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019371 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19372 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019373
19374 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19375 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19376 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19377 another server.
19378
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019379 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019380 server.
19381
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019382 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19383 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19384 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19385 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19386
19387 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19388 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19389 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19390 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19391
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019392 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19393 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19394 "use-server" rule).
19395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019396 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19397
19398 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19399 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19400
19401 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19402
19403 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19404 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19405 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19406
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019407 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19408 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019409 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019410 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19411 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19412
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019413 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19414
19415 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19416 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19417
19418 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19419
19420 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19421
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019422The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19423was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019424helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19425starvation, attacks, etc...
19426
19427The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19428alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19429easier finding and understanding.
19430
19431 Flags Reason
19432
19433 -- Normal termination.
19434
19435 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19436 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19437 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19438 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19439
19440 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19441 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19442 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19443 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19444 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19445 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019446
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019447 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19448 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019449 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019450
19451 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19452 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19453 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19454
19455 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19456 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19457 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19458 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19459 the server takes too long to respond.
19460
19461 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19462 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19463 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19464 long a time to respond.
19465
19466 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19467 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19468 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19469 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019470 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19471 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019472
19473 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19474 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19475 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19476 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19477 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019478 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019479 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19480 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19481 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19482 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19483 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19484 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19485 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19486 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019487 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019488 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19489 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19490 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019491
19492 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19493 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019494 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19495 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19496 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19497 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019498
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019499 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19500 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019502 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019503 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19504 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019505 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019506 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19507 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19508
19509 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19510 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19511 503 or 504 here.
19512
19513 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19514 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19515 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19516 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19517 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19518
19519 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19520 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019521 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019522 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19523 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19524
19525 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19526 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19527 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19528 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19529 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19530 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19531 between haproxy and the server.
19532
19533 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19534 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19535 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19536 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19537 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19538 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19539 solution is to fix the application.
19540
19541 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19542 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19543 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19544 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19545 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19546 external attacks.
19547
19548 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19549 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019550 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019551 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19552 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19553
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019554 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19555 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19556 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019557 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019558 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019559
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019560 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19561 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19562 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19563 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019564 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19565 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19566 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19567 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19568 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019569
19570 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19571 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19572 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19573 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19574
19575 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19576 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19577 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19578 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19579
19580 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19581 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19582 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19583 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19584
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019585The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19586persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19587important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19588re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19589
19590 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19591
19592 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19593 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19594 set on a GET request.
19595
19596 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19597 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019598 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019599 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19600
19601 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19602 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19603 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19604
19605 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19606 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19607 already got a cookie.
19608
19609 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19610 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19611 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19612 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19613 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19614
19615 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19616 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19617 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19618
19619 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19620 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19621 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19622
19623 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19624 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19625
19626 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19627 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19628 then advertised in the response.
19629
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196318.6. Non-printable characters
19632-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019633
19634In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19635consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19636converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19637prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19638being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19639escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19640is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19641'}' when logging headers.
19642
19643Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19644issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19645containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19646
19647Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19648the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19649performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19650
19651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196528.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19653---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019654
19655Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19656achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019657section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019658cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19659the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19660the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019661locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019662not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19663user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19664a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19665wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19666
19667 Examples :
19668 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19669 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19670
19671 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19672 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19673
19674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196758.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19676---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019677
19678Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19679proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19680the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19681server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19682
19683Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19684response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019685section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019686
19687It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019688time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19689appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019690are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19691and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19692follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19693request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19694in the logs.
19695
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019696As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19697frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19698an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19699
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019700 Example :
19701 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19702 listen proxy-out
19703 mode http
19704 option httplog
19705 option logasap
19706 log global
19707 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19708
19709 # log the name of the virtual server
19710 capture request header Host len 20
19711
19712 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19713 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19714
19715 # log the beginning of the referrer
19716 capture request header Referer len 20
19717
19718 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19719 capture response header Server len 20
19720
19721 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19722 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19723
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019724 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019725 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19726
19727 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19728 capture response header Via len 20
19729
19730 # log the URL location during a redirection
19731 capture response header Location len 20
19732
19733 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19734 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19735 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19736 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19737 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19738
19739 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19740 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19741 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19742 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019743 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019744
19745 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19746 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19747 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19748 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19749 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019750 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019751
19752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197538.9. Examples of logs
19754---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019755
19756These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19757them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19758reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19759
19760 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19761 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19762 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19763
19764 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19765 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19766
19767 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19768 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19769 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19770
19771 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19772 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19773
19774 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19775 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19776 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19777
19778 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019779 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019780 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19781 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19782
19783 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19784 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19785 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19786
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019787 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19788 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19789 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19790 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19791 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19792 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019793
19794 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019795 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019796
19797 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19798 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19799 Nothing was sent to any server.
19800
19801 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19802 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19803
19804 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19805 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019806 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019807 send a 408 return code to the client.
19808
19809 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19810 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19811
19812 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19813 5 seconds ("c----").
19814
19815 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19816 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019817 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019818
19819 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019820 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019821 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19822 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19823 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19824 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19825 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019826
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019827
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200198289. Supported filters
19829--------------------
19830
19831Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19832accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19833unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19834
19835See also : "filter"
19836
198379.1. Trace
19838----------
19839
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019840filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019841
19842 Arguments:
19843 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19844 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19845
19846 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19847 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19848 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19849 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19850
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019851 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019852 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19853 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19854 amount of the parsed data.
19855
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019856 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019857
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019858This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19859callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19860information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19861filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19862
19863Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19864tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19865a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19866
19867
198689.2. HTTP compression
19869---------------------
19870
19871filter compression
19872
19873The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19874keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019875when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19876fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19877done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19878explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19879filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19880listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19881order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019882
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019883See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19884 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019885
19886
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200198879.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19888--------------------------------------------
19889
19890filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19891
19892 Arguments :
19893
19894 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19895 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19896 parsed.
19897
19898 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19899 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19900 part must be placed in its own scope.
19901
19902The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19903external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019904streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019905exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19906also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19907
19908SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19909the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19910
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019911For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019912"doc/SPOE.txt".
19913
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100199149.4. Cache
19915----------
19916
19917filter cache <name>
19918
19919 Arguments :
19920
19921 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19922
19923The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19924"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019925cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019926other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19927case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19928is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19929filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019930listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19931order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019932
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019933See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19934 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19935
19936
199379.5. Fcgi-app
19938-------------
19939
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040019940filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019941
19942 Arguments :
19943
19944 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19945
19946The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19947request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19948reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19949used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19950implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19951used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19952fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19953used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19954order.
19955
19956See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19957 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19958
19959
1996010. FastCGI applications
19961-------------------------
19962
19963HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19964feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19965the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19966FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19967servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19968FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19969backend.
19970
19971HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19972application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19973connection.
19974
1997510.1. Setup
19976-----------
19977
1997810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19979--------------------------
19980
19981fcgi-app <name>
19982 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19983 document root must be defined.
19984
19985acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19986 Declare or complete an access list.
19987
19988 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19989 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19990 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19991 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19992 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19993
19994docroot <path>
19995 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19996 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19997 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19998
19999index <script-name>
20000 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20001 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20002 is an optional setting.
20003
20004 Example :
20005 index index.php
20006
20007log-stderr global
20008log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20009 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20010 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20011
20012 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20013 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20014
20015pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20016 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20017 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20018 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20019
20020 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20021 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20022 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20023 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20024
20025 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20026 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20027
20028path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020029 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020030 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20031 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20032 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20033 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20034 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20035 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20036 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020037
20038 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020039 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020040 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20041 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20042 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20043 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020044
20045 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020046 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20047 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020048
20049option get-values
20050no option get-values
20051 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20052
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020053 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020054 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20055
20056 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20057 application will accept.
20058
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020059 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20060 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020061
20062 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020063 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020064 option is disabled.
20065
20066 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20067 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20068 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20069 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20070 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20071 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20072
20073option keep-conn
20074no option keep-conn
20075 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20076 sending a response.
20077
20078 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20079 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20080
20081option max-reqs <reqs>
20082 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20083 accept.
20084
20085 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20086 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20087 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20088 to 1.
20089
20090option mpxs-conns
20091no option mpxs-conns
20092 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20093
20094 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20095 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20096
20097set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20098 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20099 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20100 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20101 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20102
20103 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20104 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20105 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20106
20107 Example :
20108 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20109 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20110
20111 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20112
20113
2011410.1.2. Proxy section
20115---------------------
20116
20117use-fcgi-app <name>
20118 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20119
20120 Arguments :
20121 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20122
20123 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20124 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20125 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20126 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20127 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20128
20129 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20130 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20131 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20132 application are evaluated.
20133
20134
2013510.1.3. Example
20136---------------
20137
20138 frontend front-http
20139 mode http
20140 bind *:80
20141 bind *:
20142
20143 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20144 default_backend back-static
20145
20146 backend back-static
20147 mode http
20148 server www A.B.C.D:80
20149
20150 backend back-dynamic
20151 mode http
20152 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20153 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20154
20155 fcgi-app php-fpm
20156 log-stderr global
20157 option keep-conn
20158
20159 docroot /var/www/my-app
20160 index index.php
20161 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20162
20163
2016410.2. Default parameters
20165------------------------
20166
20167A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20168the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020169script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020170applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20171
20172 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20173 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20174 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20175 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20176 | | |
20177 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20178 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20179 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20180 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20181 | | application. |
20182 | | |
20183 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20184 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20185 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20186 | | |
20187 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20188 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20189 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20190 | | the application's configuration. |
20191 | | |
20192 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20193 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20194 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20195 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20196 | | |
20197 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20198 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20199 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20200 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20201 | | be defined. |
20202 | | |
20203 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20204 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20205 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20206 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20207 | | is not set too. |
20208 | | |
20209 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20210 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20211 | | set. |
20212 | | |
20213 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20214 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20215 | | the request. |
20216 | | |
20217 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20218 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20219 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20220 | | |
20221 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20222 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20223 | | script to process the request. |
20224 | | |
20225 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20226 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20227 | | |
20228 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20229 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20230 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20231 | | |
20232 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20233 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20234 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20235 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20236 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20237 | | |
20238 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20239 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20240 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20241 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20242 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20243 | | side. |
20244 | | |
20245 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20246 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20247 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20248 | | connected to. |
20249 | | |
20250 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20251 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20252 | | |
20253 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20254 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20255 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20256 | | |
20257 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20258
20259
2026010.3. Limitations
20261------------------
20262
20263The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20264way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20265during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20266establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20267application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20268or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20269message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20270these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20271and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20272
20273Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20274request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20275requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20276
20277About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20278into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20279fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20280"http-request" ones.
20281
20282Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20283FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20284processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20285must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20286here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020287
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020288/*
20289 * Local variables:
20290 * fill-column: 79
20291 * End:
20292 */